lisp/progmodes/python.el: Updated Copyright years.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob3c7a7efdd712c26e4572e711d0f8c7012c231b42
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
50 #include "systime.h"
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
92 #include <unistd.h>
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
97 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
98 #endif
99 #endif
101 #ifdef USE_LUCID
102 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
103 #endif
105 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
106 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
107 #define HACK_EDITRES
108 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
109 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
111 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
113 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
114 #if defined USE_MOTIF
115 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
116 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
117 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
119 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
120 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
121 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
123 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
125 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
126 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
127 #ifndef XtNpickTop
128 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
129 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
130 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
131 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
133 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
135 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
136 #include "widget.h"
137 #ifndef XtNinitialState
138 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
139 #endif
140 #endif
142 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
144 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
145 #ifdef USE_XIM
146 int use_xim = 1;
147 #else
148 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
149 #endif
153 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
154 start. */
156 static int any_help_event_p;
158 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
159 static Lisp_Object last_window;
161 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
162 use. */
164 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
166 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
167 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
168 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
169 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
171 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
173 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
174 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
175 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
176 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
178 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
180 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
182 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
184 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
186 static struct {
187 struct frame *f;
188 int eventtype;
189 } pending_event_wait;
191 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
192 /* The application context for Xt use. */
193 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
194 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
196 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
198 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
199 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
201 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
202 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
203 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
205 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
207 /* Mouse movement.
209 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
210 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
211 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
212 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
214 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
216 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
217 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
218 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
219 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
220 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
221 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
222 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
223 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
224 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
225 is off. */
227 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
229 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
230 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
231 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
233 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
235 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
236 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
237 an ordinary motion.
239 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
240 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
241 event. */
243 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
245 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
246 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
247 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
248 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
249 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
250 it's somewhat accurate. */
252 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
254 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
256 static Time last_user_time;
258 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
259 events. */
261 static int volatile input_signal_count;
263 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
265 static int x_noop_count;
267 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
269 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
270 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
272 #ifdef USE_GTK
273 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
274 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
276 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
277 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
278 #endif
280 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
281 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
283 enum xembed_info
285 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
288 enum xembed_message
290 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
291 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
292 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
293 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
294 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
295 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
296 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
297 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
299 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
300 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
301 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
302 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
303 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
306 /* Used in x_flush. */
308 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
309 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
310 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
311 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
312 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
313 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
315 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
316 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
317 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
318 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
319 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
320 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
321 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
322 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
323 static void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int) NO_RETURN;
324 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
325 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
326 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
327 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
328 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
329 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
330 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
331 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
332 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
333 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
334 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
335 enum text_cursor_kinds);
337 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
338 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
339 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
340 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
341 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
342 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
343 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
344 enum scroll_bar_part *,
345 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
346 Time *);
347 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
348 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
349 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
350 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
351 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
352 int *, struct input_event *);
353 #ifdef USE_GTK
354 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
355 #endif
356 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
357 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
358 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
359 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
360 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
361 static void x_initialize (void);
364 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
366 static void
367 x_flush (struct frame *f)
369 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
370 connection may be broken. */
371 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
372 return;
374 BLOCK_INPUT;
375 if (f == NULL)
377 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
378 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
379 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
380 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
382 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
383 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
384 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
388 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
389 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
390 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
391 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
392 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
393 performance. */
395 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
398 /***********************************************************************
399 Debugging
400 ***********************************************************************/
402 #if 0
404 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
405 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
407 struct record
409 char *locus;
410 int type;
413 struct record event_record[100];
415 int event_record_index;
417 void
418 record_event (char *locus, int type)
420 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
421 event_record_index = 0;
423 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
424 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
425 event_record_index++;
428 #endif /* 0 */
432 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
434 struct x_display_info *
435 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
437 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
439 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
440 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
441 return dpyinfo;
443 return 0;
446 static Window
447 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
449 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
450 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
451 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
453 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
455 Window root;
456 Window *children;
457 unsigned int nchildren;
459 win = wi;
460 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
461 XFree (children);
464 return win;
467 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
469 void
470 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
473 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
474 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
475 double alpha = 1.0;
476 double alpha_min = 1.0;
477 unsigned long opac;
478 Window parent;
480 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
481 alpha = f->alpha[0];
482 else
483 alpha = f->alpha[1];
485 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
486 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
487 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
488 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
490 if (alpha < 0.0)
491 return;
492 else if (alpha > 1.0)
493 alpha = 1.0;
494 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
495 alpha = alpha_min;
497 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
499 x_catch_errors (dpy);
501 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
502 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
503 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
504 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
506 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
507 if (parent != None)
508 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
509 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
510 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
512 /* return unless necessary */
514 unsigned char *data;
515 Atom actual;
516 int rc, format;
517 unsigned long n, left;
519 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
520 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
521 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
522 &data);
524 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
526 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
527 XFree ((void *) data);
528 if (value == opac)
530 x_uncatch_errors ();
531 return;
536 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
537 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
538 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
539 x_uncatch_errors ();
543 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
545 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
549 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
551 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
555 /***********************************************************************
556 Starting and ending an update
557 ***********************************************************************/
559 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
560 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
561 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
562 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
563 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
565 static void
566 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
568 /* Nothing to do. */
572 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
573 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
574 position of W. */
576 static void
577 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
579 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
580 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
582 updated_window = w;
583 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
585 BLOCK_INPUT;
587 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
589 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
590 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
592 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
593 highlighting. */
594 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
595 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
598 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
602 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
604 static void
605 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
607 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
608 struct face *face;
610 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
611 if (face)
612 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
613 face->foreground);
615 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
616 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
619 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
621 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
622 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
624 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
625 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
626 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
628 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
629 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
630 here. */
632 static void
633 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
635 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
637 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
639 BLOCK_INPUT;
641 if (cursor_on_p)
642 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
643 output_cursor.vpos,
644 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
646 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
647 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
649 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
652 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
653 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
654 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
656 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
657 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
658 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
661 updated_window = NULL;
665 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
666 update_end. */
668 static void
669 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
671 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
672 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
674 #ifndef XFlush
675 BLOCK_INPUT;
676 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
677 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
678 #endif
682 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
683 complete update has been performed. The global variable
684 updated_window is not available here. */
686 static void
687 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
689 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
691 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
693 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
694 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
696 BLOCK_INPUT;
697 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
698 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
699 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
700 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
701 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
702 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
708 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
709 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
710 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
711 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
712 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
713 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
715 static void
716 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
718 struct window *w = updated_window;
719 struct frame *f;
720 int width, height;
722 xassert (w);
724 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
725 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
727 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
728 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
729 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
730 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
731 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
732 overhead is very small. */
733 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
734 && desired_row->full_width_p
735 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
736 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
737 width != 0)
738 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
739 height > 0))
741 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
743 BLOCK_INPUT;
744 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
745 0, y, width, height, False);
746 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
747 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
748 y, width, height, False);
749 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
753 static void
754 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
756 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
757 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
758 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
759 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
760 struct face *face = p->face;
762 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
763 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
765 if (!p->overlay_p)
767 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
769 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
770 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
771 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
772 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
773 if (face->stipple)
774 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
775 else
776 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
778 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
779 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
780 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
781 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
782 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
783 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
784 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
785 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
787 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
789 if (sb_width > 0)
791 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
792 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
793 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
795 if (bx < 0)
797 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
798 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
799 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
800 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
801 bx = bar_area_x;
802 if (bx >= 0)
804 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
806 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
807 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
808 row->y));
809 ny = row->visible_height;
812 else
814 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
816 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
817 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
819 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
820 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
824 #endif
825 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
826 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
828 if (!face->stipple)
829 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
832 if (p->which)
834 char *bits;
835 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
836 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
837 XGCValues gcv;
839 if (p->wd > 8)
840 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
841 else
842 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
844 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
845 by the server. */
846 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
847 (p->cursor_p
848 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
849 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
850 : face->foreground),
851 face->background, depth);
853 if (p->overlay_p)
855 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
856 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
857 bits, p->wd, p->h,
858 1, 0, 1);
859 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
860 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
861 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
862 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
865 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
866 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
867 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
869 if (p->overlay_p)
871 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
872 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
873 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
877 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
882 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
883 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
884 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
885 rarely happens). */
887 static void
888 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
892 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
893 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
895 static void
896 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
901 /***********************************************************************
902 Glyph display
903 ***********************************************************************/
907 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
909 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
910 int);
911 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
912 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
913 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
915 static void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int) NO_RETURN;
916 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
917 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
918 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
919 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
920 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
921 unsigned long *, double, int);
922 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
923 double, int, unsigned long);
924 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
925 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
926 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
927 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
928 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
929 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
930 int, int, int);
931 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
932 int, int, int, int, int, int,
933 XRectangle *);
934 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
935 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
936 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
938 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
939 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
940 #endif
943 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
944 face. */
946 static void
947 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
949 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
950 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
951 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
952 && !s->cmp)
953 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
954 else
956 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
957 XGCValues xgcv;
958 unsigned long mask;
960 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
961 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
963 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
964 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
965 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
966 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
967 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
968 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
969 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
971 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
972 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
973 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
975 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
976 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
979 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
980 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
981 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
983 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
984 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
985 mask, &xgcv);
986 else
987 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
988 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
990 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
995 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
997 static void
998 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1000 int face_id;
1001 struct face *face;
1003 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1004 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1005 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1006 if (face == NULL)
1007 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1009 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1010 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1011 else
1012 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1013 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1014 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1016 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1017 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1018 else
1020 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1021 except for FONT. */
1022 XGCValues xgcv;
1023 unsigned long mask;
1025 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1026 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1027 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1028 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1030 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1031 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1032 mask, &xgcv);
1033 else
1034 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1035 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1037 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1040 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1044 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1045 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1046 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1048 static inline void
1049 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1051 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1055 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1056 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1057 pattern. */
1059 static inline void
1060 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1062 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1064 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1066 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1067 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1069 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1071 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1072 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1074 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1076 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1077 s->stippled_p = 0;
1079 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1081 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1082 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1084 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1085 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1087 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1088 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1090 else
1092 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1093 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1096 /* GC must have been set. */
1097 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1101 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1102 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1104 static inline void
1105 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1107 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1108 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1110 if (n > 0)
1111 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1112 s->num_clips = n;
1116 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1117 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1118 the area of SRC. */
1120 static void
1121 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1123 XRectangle r;
1125 r.x = src->x;
1126 r.width = src->width;
1127 r.y = src->y;
1128 r.height = src->height;
1129 dst->clip[0] = r;
1130 dst->num_clips = 1;
1131 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1135 /* RIF:
1136 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1138 static void
1139 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1141 if (s->cmp == NULL
1142 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1143 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1145 struct font_metrics metrics;
1147 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1149 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1150 struct font *font = s->font;
1151 int i;
1153 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1154 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1155 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1157 else
1159 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1161 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1163 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1164 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1165 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1167 else if (s->cmp)
1169 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1170 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1175 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1177 static inline void
1178 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1180 XGCValues xgcv;
1181 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1182 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1183 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1184 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1188 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1189 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1190 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1191 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1192 contains the first component of a composition. */
1194 static void
1195 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1197 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1198 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1199 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1201 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1203 if (s->stippled_p)
1205 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1206 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1207 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1208 s->y + box_line_width,
1209 s->background_width,
1210 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1211 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1212 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1214 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1215 || s->font_not_found_p
1216 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1217 || force_p)
1219 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1220 s->background_width,
1221 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1222 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1228 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1230 static void
1231 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1233 int i, x;
1235 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1236 of S to the right of that box line. */
1237 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1238 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1239 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1240 else
1241 x = s->x;
1243 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1244 loaded. */
1245 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1247 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1249 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1250 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1251 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1252 s->height - 1);
1253 x += g->pixel_width;
1256 else
1258 struct font *font = s->font;
1259 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1260 int y;
1262 if (font->vertical_centering)
1263 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1265 y = s->ybase - boff;
1266 if (s->for_overlaps
1267 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1268 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1269 else
1270 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1271 if (s->face->overstrike)
1272 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1276 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1278 static void
1279 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1281 int i, j, x;
1282 struct font *font = s->font;
1284 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1285 of S to the right of that box line. */
1286 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1287 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1288 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1289 else
1290 x = s->x;
1292 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1293 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1294 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1295 this composition. */
1297 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1298 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1299 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1301 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1302 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1303 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1305 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1307 int y = s->ybase;
1309 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1310 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1311 space on the left or right. */
1312 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1314 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1315 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1317 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1318 if (s->face->overstrike)
1319 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1322 else
1324 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1325 Lisp_Object glyph;
1326 int y = s->ybase;
1327 int width = 0;
1329 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1331 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1332 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1333 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1334 else
1336 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1338 if (j < i)
1340 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1341 if (s->face->overstrike)
1342 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1343 x += width;
1345 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1346 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1347 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1348 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1349 if (s->face->overstrike)
1350 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1351 x += wadjust;
1352 j = i + 1;
1353 width = 0;
1356 if (j < i)
1358 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1359 if (s->face->overstrike)
1360 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1366 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1368 static void
1369 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1371 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1372 XChar2b char2b[8];
1373 int x, i, j;
1375 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1376 of S to the right of that box line. */
1377 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1378 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1379 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1380 else
1381 x = s->x;
1383 s->char2b = char2b;
1385 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1387 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1388 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1390 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1392 if (len > 0
1393 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1394 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1395 >= 1))
1397 Lisp_Object acronym
1398 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1399 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1400 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1401 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1402 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1403 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1406 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1408 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1409 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1410 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1411 str = buf;
1414 if (str)
1416 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1417 unsigned code;
1419 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1420 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1422 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1423 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1425 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1426 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1427 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1429 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1430 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1431 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1434 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1435 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1436 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1437 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1438 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1439 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1443 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1445 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1446 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1447 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1448 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1449 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1452 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1453 cannot be determined. */
1455 static struct frame *
1456 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1458 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1459 Lisp_Object tail;
1460 struct frame *f;
1462 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1464 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1465 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1466 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1467 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1468 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1469 widget = XtParent (widget);
1471 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1472 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1473 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1474 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1475 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1476 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1477 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1478 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1479 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1480 return f;
1482 abort ();
1486 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1488 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1489 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1490 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1491 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1492 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1493 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1496 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1497 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1499 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1500 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1503 #endif
1506 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1507 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1509 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1511 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1512 sizeof (Screen *)},
1513 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1514 sizeof (Colormap)}
1518 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1519 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1521 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1524 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1526 DPY is the display we are working on.
1528 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1529 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1530 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1531 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1533 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1534 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1536 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1537 we allocated the color or not.
1539 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1541 static Boolean
1542 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1543 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1544 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1546 Screen *screen;
1547 Colormap cmap;
1548 Pixel pixel;
1549 String color_name;
1550 XColor color;
1552 if (*nargs != 2)
1554 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1555 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1556 "XtToolkitError",
1557 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1558 return False;
1561 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1562 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1563 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1565 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1567 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1568 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1570 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1572 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1573 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1575 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1576 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1578 pixel = color.pixel;
1579 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1581 else
1583 String params[1];
1584 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1586 params[0] = color_name;
1587 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1588 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1589 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1590 params, &nparams);
1591 return False;
1594 if (to->addr != NULL)
1596 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1598 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1599 return False;
1602 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1604 else
1606 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1607 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1610 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1611 return True;
1615 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1616 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1617 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1619 APP is the application context in which we work.
1621 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1622 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1623 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1625 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1627 static void
1628 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1629 Cardinal *nargs)
1631 if (*nargs != 2)
1633 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1634 "XtToolkitError",
1635 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1636 NULL, NULL);
1638 else if (closure != NULL)
1640 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1641 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1642 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1643 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1644 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1649 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1652 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1653 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1654 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1655 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1657 static const XColor *
1658 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1660 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1662 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1664 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1665 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1666 int i;
1668 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1669 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1670 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1672 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1673 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1675 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1676 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1679 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1680 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1684 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1685 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1687 void
1688 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1690 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1692 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1694 int i;
1695 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1697 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1698 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1699 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1700 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1703 else
1704 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1708 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1709 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1711 void
1712 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1714 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1718 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1719 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1720 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1721 allocated. */
1723 static int
1724 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1726 int rc;
1728 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1729 if (rc == 0)
1731 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1732 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1733 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1734 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1735 int nearest, i;
1736 int max_color_delta = 255;
1737 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1738 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1739 int ncells;
1740 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1742 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1744 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1745 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1746 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1747 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1749 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1751 nearest = i;
1752 nearest_delta = delta;
1756 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1757 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1758 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1759 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1761 else
1763 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1764 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1765 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1766 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1767 XColor *cached_color;
1769 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1770 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1771 (cached_color->red != color->red
1772 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1773 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1775 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1776 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1777 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1781 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1782 if (rc)
1783 register_color (color->pixel);
1784 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1786 return rc;
1790 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1791 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1792 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1793 allocated. */
1796 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1798 gamma_correct (f, color);
1799 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1803 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1804 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1805 get color reference counts right. */
1807 unsigned long
1808 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1810 XColor color;
1812 color.pixel = pixel;
1813 BLOCK_INPUT;
1814 x_query_color (f, &color);
1815 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1816 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1817 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1818 register_color (pixel);
1819 #endif
1820 return color.pixel;
1824 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1825 boosted.
1827 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1828 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1829 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1830 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1831 use an additional additive factor.
1833 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1834 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1835 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1838 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1839 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1840 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1841 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1842 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1843 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1845 static int
1846 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1848 XColor color, new;
1849 long bright;
1850 int success_p;
1852 /* Get RGB color values. */
1853 color.pixel = *pixel;
1854 x_query_color (f, &color);
1856 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1857 xassert (factor >= 0);
1858 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1859 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1860 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1862 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1863 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1865 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1866 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1867 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1868 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1869 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1871 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1872 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1873 /* The additive adjustment. */
1874 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1876 if (factor < 1)
1878 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1879 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1880 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1882 else
1884 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1885 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1886 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1890 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1891 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1892 if (success_p)
1894 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1896 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1897 delta to the RGB values. */
1898 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1900 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1901 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1902 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1903 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1905 else
1906 success_p = 1;
1907 *pixel = new.pixel;
1910 return success_p;
1914 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1915 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1916 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1917 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1918 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1919 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1921 static void
1922 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1924 XGCValues xgcv;
1925 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1926 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1927 unsigned long pixel;
1928 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1929 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1930 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1931 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1933 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1934 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1936 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1937 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1938 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1939 if (relief->gc
1940 && relief->allocated_p)
1942 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1943 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1946 /* Allocate new color. */
1947 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1948 pixel = background;
1949 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1950 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1952 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1953 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1956 if (relief->gc == 0)
1958 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1959 mask |= GCStipple;
1960 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1962 else
1963 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1967 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1969 static void
1970 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1972 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1973 unsigned long color;
1975 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1976 color = s->face->box_color;
1977 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1978 && s->img->pixmap
1979 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1980 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1981 else
1983 XGCValues xgcv;
1985 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1986 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1987 color = xgcv.background;
1990 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1991 || color != di->relief_background)
1993 di->relief_background = color;
1994 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1995 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1996 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1997 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2002 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2003 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2004 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2005 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2006 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2007 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2008 when drawing. */
2010 static void
2011 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2012 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2013 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2014 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2016 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2017 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2018 int i;
2019 GC gc;
2021 if (raised_p)
2022 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2023 else
2024 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2025 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2027 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2028 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2029 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2030 corner pixels. */
2032 /* Top. */
2033 if (top_p)
2035 if (width == 1)
2036 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2037 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2038 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2040 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2041 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2042 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2043 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2046 /* Left. */
2047 if (left_p)
2049 if (width == 1)
2050 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2052 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2053 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2055 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2056 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2057 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2060 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2061 if (raised_p)
2062 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2063 else
2064 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2065 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2067 if (width > 1)
2069 /* Outermost top line. */
2070 if (top_p)
2071 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2072 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2073 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2075 /* Outermost left line. */
2076 if (left_p)
2077 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2080 /* Bottom. */
2081 if (bot_p)
2083 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2084 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2085 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2086 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2087 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2088 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2089 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2092 /* Right. */
2093 if (right_p)
2095 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2096 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2097 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2098 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2099 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2102 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2106 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2107 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2108 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2109 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2110 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2111 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2113 static void
2114 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2115 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2116 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2118 XGCValues xgcv;
2120 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2121 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2122 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2124 /* Top. */
2125 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2126 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2128 /* Left. */
2129 if (left_p)
2130 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2131 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2133 /* Bottom. */
2134 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2135 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2137 /* Right. */
2138 if (right_p)
2139 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2140 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2142 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2143 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2147 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2149 static void
2150 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2152 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2153 int left_p, right_p;
2154 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2155 XRectangle clip_rect;
2157 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2158 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2159 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2161 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2162 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2163 ? s->first_glyph
2164 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2166 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2167 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2168 left_x = s->x;
2169 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2170 ? last_x - 1
2171 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2172 top_y = s->y;
2173 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2175 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2176 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2177 && (s->prev == NULL
2178 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2179 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2180 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2181 && (s->next == NULL
2182 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2184 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2186 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2187 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2188 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2189 else
2191 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2192 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2193 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2198 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2200 static void
2201 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2203 int x = s->x;
2204 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2206 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2207 right of that line. */
2208 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2209 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2210 && s->slice.x == 0)
2211 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2213 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2214 by that margin. */
2215 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2216 x += s->img->hmargin;
2217 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2218 y += s->img->vmargin;
2220 if (s->img->pixmap)
2222 if (s->img->mask)
2224 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2225 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2226 trust on the shape extension to be available
2227 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2228 manually. */
2229 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2230 | GCFunction);
2231 XGCValues xgcv;
2232 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2234 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2235 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2236 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2237 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2238 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2240 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2241 image_rect.x = x;
2242 image_rect.y = y;
2243 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2244 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2245 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2246 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2247 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2248 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2250 else
2252 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2254 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2255 image_rect.x = x;
2256 image_rect.y = y;
2257 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2258 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2259 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2260 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2261 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2262 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2264 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2265 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2266 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2267 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2268 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2269 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2270 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2272 int relief = s->img->relief;
2273 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2274 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2275 x - relief, y - relief,
2276 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2277 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2281 else
2282 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2283 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2284 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2288 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2290 static void
2291 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2293 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2294 int extra_x, extra_y;
2295 XRectangle r;
2296 int x = s->x;
2297 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2299 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2300 right of that line. */
2301 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2302 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2303 && s->slice.x == 0)
2304 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2306 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2307 by that margin. */
2308 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2309 x += s->img->hmargin;
2310 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2311 y += s->img->vmargin;
2313 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2314 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2316 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2317 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2319 else
2321 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2322 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2325 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2326 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2328 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2329 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2330 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2332 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2333 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2335 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2336 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2339 x0 = x - thick - extra_x;
2340 y0 = y - thick - extra_y;
2341 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra_x;
2342 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra_y;
2344 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2345 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2346 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2347 s->slice.y == 0,
2348 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2349 s->slice.x == 0,
2350 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2351 &r);
2355 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2357 static void
2358 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2360 int x = 0;
2361 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2363 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2364 right of that line. */
2365 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2366 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2367 && s->slice.x == 0)
2368 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2370 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2371 by that margin. */
2372 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2373 x += s->img->hmargin;
2374 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2375 y += s->img->vmargin;
2377 if (s->img->pixmap)
2379 if (s->img->mask)
2381 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2382 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2383 trust on the shape extension to be available
2384 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2385 manually. */
2386 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2387 | GCFunction);
2388 XGCValues xgcv;
2390 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2391 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2392 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2393 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2394 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2396 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2397 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2398 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2399 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2401 else
2403 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2404 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2405 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2407 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2408 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2409 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2410 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2411 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2412 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2413 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2415 int r = s->img->relief;
2416 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2417 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2418 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2419 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2423 else
2424 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2425 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2426 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2430 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2431 give the rectangle to draw. */
2433 static void
2434 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2436 if (s->stippled_p)
2438 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2439 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2440 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2441 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2443 else
2444 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2448 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2450 s->y
2451 s->x +-------------------------
2452 | s->face->box
2454 | +-------------------------
2455 | | s->img->margin
2457 | | +-------------------
2458 | | | the image
2462 static void
2463 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2465 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2466 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2467 int height;
2468 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2470 height = s->height;
2471 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2472 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2473 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2474 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2476 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2477 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2478 flickering. */
2479 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2480 if (height > s->slice.height
2481 || s->img->hmargin
2482 || s->img->vmargin
2483 || s->img->mask
2484 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2485 || s->width != s->background_width)
2487 if (s->img->mask)
2489 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2490 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2491 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2492 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2493 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2495 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2496 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2497 s->background_width,
2498 s->height, depth);
2500 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2501 pixmap. */
2502 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2504 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2505 if (s->stippled_p)
2507 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2508 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2509 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2510 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2511 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2512 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2513 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2515 else
2517 XGCValues xgcv;
2518 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2519 &xgcv);
2520 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2521 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2522 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2523 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2526 else
2528 int x = s->x;
2529 int y = s->y;
2531 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2532 && s->slice.x == 0)
2533 x += box_line_hwidth;
2535 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2536 y += box_line_vwidth;
2538 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2541 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2544 /* Draw the foreground. */
2545 if (pixmap != None)
2547 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2548 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2549 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2550 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2551 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2553 else
2554 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2556 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2557 if (s->img->relief
2558 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2559 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2560 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2564 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2566 static void
2567 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2569 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2571 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2572 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2574 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2575 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2576 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2577 int x = s->x;
2579 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2581 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2583 if (x < left_x)
2585 background_width -= left_x - x;
2586 x = left_x;
2589 else
2591 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2592 stretch glyph. */
2593 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2595 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2596 background_width -= x - right_x;
2597 x += background_width;
2599 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2600 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2601 x -= width;
2603 /* Draw cursor. */
2604 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2606 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2607 if (width < background_width)
2609 int y = s->y;
2610 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2611 XRectangle r;
2612 GC gc;
2614 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2615 x += width;
2616 else
2617 x = s->x;
2618 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2619 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2621 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2622 gc = s->gc;
2624 else
2625 gc = s->face->gc;
2627 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2628 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2630 if (s->face->stipple)
2632 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2633 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2634 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2635 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2637 else
2639 XGCValues xgcv;
2640 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2641 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2642 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2643 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2647 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2649 int background_width = s->background_width;
2650 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2652 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2653 except for header line and mode line. */
2654 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2656 background_width -= left_x - x;
2657 x = left_x;
2659 if (background_width > 0)
2660 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2663 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2667 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2669 static void
2670 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2672 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2674 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2675 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2676 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2677 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2679 int width;
2680 struct glyph_string *next;
2682 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2683 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2684 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2685 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2687 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2688 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2689 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2690 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2691 else
2692 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2693 next->num_clips = 0;
2697 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2698 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2700 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2701 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2702 if (!s->for_overlaps
2703 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2704 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2705 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2708 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2709 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2710 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2711 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2712 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2714 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2715 && !s->clip_tail
2716 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2717 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2718 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2719 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2720 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2721 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2722 else
2723 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2725 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2727 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2728 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2729 break;
2731 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2732 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2733 break;
2735 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2736 if (s->for_overlaps)
2737 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2738 else
2739 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2740 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2741 break;
2743 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2744 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2745 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2746 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2747 else
2748 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2749 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2750 break;
2752 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2753 if (s->for_overlaps)
2754 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2755 else
2756 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2757 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2758 break;
2760 default:
2761 abort ();
2764 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2766 /* Draw underline. */
2767 if (s->face->underline_p)
2769 unsigned long thickness, position;
2770 int y;
2772 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2774 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2775 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2776 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2778 else
2780 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2781 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2782 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2783 else
2784 thickness = 1;
2785 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2786 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2787 else
2789 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2790 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2791 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2792 specs, and its default is
2794 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2795 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2797 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2798 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2799 position = s->font->underline_position;
2800 else if (s->font)
2801 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2802 else
2803 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2805 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2807 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2808 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2809 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2810 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2811 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2812 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2813 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2814 s->underline_position = position;
2815 y = s->ybase + position;
2816 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2817 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2818 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2819 else
2821 XGCValues xgcv;
2822 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2823 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2824 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2825 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2826 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2830 /* Draw overline. */
2831 if (s->face->overline_p)
2833 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2835 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2836 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2837 s->width, h);
2838 else
2840 XGCValues xgcv;
2841 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2842 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2843 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2844 s->width, h);
2845 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2849 /* Draw strike-through. */
2850 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2852 unsigned long h = 1;
2853 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2855 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2856 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2857 s->width, h);
2858 else
2860 XGCValues xgcv;
2861 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2862 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2863 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2864 s->width, h);
2865 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2869 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2870 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2871 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2873 if (s->prev)
2875 struct glyph_string *prev;
2877 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2878 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2879 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2881 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2882 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2883 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2885 prev->hl = s->hl;
2886 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2887 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2888 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2889 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2890 else
2891 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2892 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2893 prev->hl = save;
2894 prev->num_clips = 0;
2898 if (s->next)
2900 struct glyph_string *next;
2902 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2903 if (next->hl != s->hl
2904 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2906 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2907 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2908 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2910 next->hl = s->hl;
2911 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2912 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2913 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2914 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2915 else
2916 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2917 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2918 next->hl = save;
2919 next->num_clips = 0;
2924 /* Reset clipping. */
2925 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2926 s->num_clips = 0;
2929 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2931 static void
2932 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2934 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2935 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2936 x, y, width, height,
2937 x + shift_by, y);
2940 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2941 for X frames. */
2943 static void
2944 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2946 abort ();
2950 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2951 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2953 void
2954 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2956 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2957 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2961 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2963 static void
2964 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2966 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2967 longer visible. */
2968 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2969 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2970 output_cursor.x = -1;
2972 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2973 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2974 BLOCK_INPUT;
2976 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2978 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2979 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2980 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2982 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2983 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2984 redisplay, do it here. */
2985 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2986 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2987 #endif
2989 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2991 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2996 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2998 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2999 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
3001 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3004 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
3005 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
3007 static int
3008 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
3010 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
3011 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
3012 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
3014 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
3015 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
3016 y.tv_sec += nsec;
3019 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
3021 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3022 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3023 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3026 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3027 positive. */
3028 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3029 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3031 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3032 negative. */
3033 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3036 static void
3037 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3039 BLOCK_INPUT;
3042 #ifdef USE_GTK
3043 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3044 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3045 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3046 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3047 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3048 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3049 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3050 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3051 do { \
3052 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3053 cairo_fill (cr); \
3055 while (0)
3056 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3057 GdkGCValues vals;
3058 GdkGC *gc;
3059 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3060 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3061 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3062 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3063 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3064 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3065 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3066 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3067 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3068 GC gc;
3070 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3071 pixels into background pixels. */
3073 XGCValues values;
3075 values.function = GXxor;
3076 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3077 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3079 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3080 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3082 #endif
3084 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3085 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3086 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3087 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3088 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3089 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3090 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3092 int width;
3094 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3095 edge it is next to. */
3096 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3098 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3099 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3100 break;
3102 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3103 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3104 break;
3106 default:
3107 break;
3110 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3112 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3113 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3115 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3116 flash_left,
3117 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3118 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3119 width, flash_height);
3120 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3121 flash_left,
3122 (height - flash_height
3123 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3124 width, flash_height);
3127 else
3128 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3129 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3130 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3131 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3133 x_flush (f);
3136 struct timeval wakeup;
3138 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3140 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3141 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3142 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3143 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3145 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3146 available. */
3147 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3149 struct timeval current;
3150 struct timeval timeout;
3152 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3154 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3155 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3156 break;
3158 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3159 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3160 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3162 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3163 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3167 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3168 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3170 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3171 flash_left,
3172 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3173 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3174 width, flash_height);
3175 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3176 flash_left,
3177 (height - flash_height
3178 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3179 width, flash_height);
3181 else
3182 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3183 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3184 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3185 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3187 #ifdef USE_GTK
3188 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3189 cairo_destroy (cr);
3190 #else
3191 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3192 #endif
3193 #undef XFillRectangle
3194 #else
3195 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3196 #endif
3197 x_flush (f);
3201 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3204 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3207 static void
3208 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3210 BLOCK_INPUT;
3211 if (invisible)
3213 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3214 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3215 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3217 else
3218 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3219 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3220 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3221 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3225 /* Make audible bell. */
3227 static void
3228 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3230 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3232 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3233 if (visible_bell)
3234 XTflash (f);
3235 else
3236 #endif
3238 BLOCK_INPUT;
3239 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3240 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3241 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3247 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3248 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3249 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3250 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3252 static void
3253 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3255 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3260 /***********************************************************************
3261 Line Dance
3262 ***********************************************************************/
3264 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3265 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3267 static void
3268 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3270 abort ();
3274 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3276 static void
3277 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3279 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3280 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3282 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3283 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3284 fringe of W. */
3285 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3287 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3288 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3289 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3290 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3291 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3292 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3293 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3294 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3296 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3298 if (sb_width > 0)
3300 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3301 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3302 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3304 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3306 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3307 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3309 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3310 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3313 #endif
3315 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3316 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3317 bottom_y = y + height;
3319 if (to_y < from_y)
3321 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3322 line at the bottom. */
3323 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3324 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3325 else
3326 height = run->height;
3328 else
3330 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3331 at the bottom. */
3332 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3333 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3334 else
3335 height = run->height;
3338 BLOCK_INPUT;
3340 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3341 updated_window = w;
3342 x_clear_cursor (w);
3344 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3345 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3346 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3347 x, from_y,
3348 width, height,
3349 x, to_y);
3351 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3356 /***********************************************************************
3357 Exposure Events
3358 ***********************************************************************/
3361 static void
3362 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3364 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3365 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3366 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3367 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3368 BLOCK_INPUT;
3369 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3370 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3371 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3372 because of this (bug#9310). */
3373 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3374 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3375 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3376 x_uncatch_errors ();
3377 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3378 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3379 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3382 static void
3383 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3385 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3386 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3387 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3388 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3389 BLOCK_INPUT;
3390 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3391 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3392 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3393 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3394 x_uncatch_errors ();
3395 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3396 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3397 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3400 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3401 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3402 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3403 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3404 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3406 static void
3407 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3409 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3411 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3413 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3414 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3415 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3417 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3418 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3420 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3421 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3422 else
3423 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3426 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3429 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3430 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3431 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3433 static void
3434 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3436 if (type == FocusIn)
3438 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3440 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3441 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3443 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3444 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3445 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3446 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3447 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3449 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3450 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3454 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3456 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3457 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3458 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3459 #endif
3461 else if (type == FocusOut)
3463 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3465 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3467 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3468 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3471 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3472 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3473 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3474 #endif
3475 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3476 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3480 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3481 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3483 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3485 static void
3486 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3488 struct frame *frame;
3490 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3491 if (! frame)
3492 return;
3494 switch (event->type)
3496 case EnterNotify:
3497 case LeaveNotify:
3499 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3500 int focus_state
3501 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3503 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3504 && event->xcrossing.focus
3505 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3506 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3507 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3508 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3510 break;
3512 case FocusIn:
3513 case FocusOut:
3514 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3515 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3516 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3517 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3518 break;
3520 case ClientMessage:
3521 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3523 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3524 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3525 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3527 break;
3532 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3533 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3535 void
3536 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3538 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3540 #endif
3542 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3543 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3544 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3546 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3547 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3548 the appropriate X display info. */
3550 static void
3551 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3553 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3556 static void
3557 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3559 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3561 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3563 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3564 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3565 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3566 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3567 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3569 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3570 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3573 else
3574 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3576 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3578 if (old_highlight)
3579 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3580 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3581 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3587 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3589 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3590 static void
3591 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3593 int min_code, max_code;
3594 KeySym *syms;
3595 int syms_per_code;
3596 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3598 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3599 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3600 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3601 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3602 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3604 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3606 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3607 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3608 &syms_per_code);
3609 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3611 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3612 Alt keysyms are on. */
3614 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3615 int found_alt_or_meta;
3617 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3619 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3620 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3622 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3624 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3625 if (code == 0)
3626 continue;
3628 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3630 int code_col;
3632 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3634 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3636 switch (sym)
3638 case XK_Meta_L:
3639 case XK_Meta_R:
3640 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3641 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3642 break;
3644 case XK_Alt_L:
3645 case XK_Alt_R:
3646 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3647 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3648 break;
3650 case XK_Hyper_L:
3651 case XK_Hyper_R:
3652 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3653 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3654 code_col = syms_per_code;
3655 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3656 break;
3658 case XK_Super_L:
3659 case XK_Super_R:
3660 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3661 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3662 code_col = syms_per_code;
3663 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3664 break;
3666 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3667 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3668 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3669 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3670 code_col = syms_per_code;
3671 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3672 break;
3680 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3681 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3683 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3684 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3687 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3688 make them just meta, not alt. */
3689 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3691 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3694 XFree ((char *) syms);
3695 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3698 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3699 Emacs uses. */
3702 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3704 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3705 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3706 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3707 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3708 Lisp_Object tem;
3710 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3711 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3712 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3713 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3714 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3715 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3716 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3717 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3719 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3720 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3721 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3722 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3723 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3724 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3727 static int
3728 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3730 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3731 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3732 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3733 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3735 Lisp_Object tem;
3737 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3738 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3739 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3740 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3741 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3742 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3743 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3744 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3747 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3748 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3749 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3750 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3751 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3752 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3755 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3757 char *
3758 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3760 char *value;
3762 BLOCK_INPUT;
3763 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3764 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3766 return value;
3771 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3773 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3775 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3776 the mouse. */
3778 static Lisp_Object
3779 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3781 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3782 otherwise. */
3783 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3784 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3785 result->timestamp = event->time;
3786 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3787 event->state)
3788 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3789 ? up_modifier
3790 : down_modifier));
3792 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3793 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3794 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3795 result->arg = Qnil;
3796 return Qnil;
3800 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3801 The input handler calls this.
3803 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3804 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3805 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3806 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3808 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3809 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3811 static int
3812 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3814 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3815 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3816 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3818 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3819 return 0;
3821 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3823 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3824 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3825 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3826 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3827 return 1;
3831 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3832 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3833 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3834 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3835 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3836 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3838 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3839 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3840 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3841 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3842 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3843 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3844 return 1;
3847 return 0;
3851 /************************************************************************
3852 Mouse Face
3853 ************************************************************************/
3855 static void
3856 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3858 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3859 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3860 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3861 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3862 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3867 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3868 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3870 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3871 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3872 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3873 position on the scroll bar.
3875 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3876 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3877 the mouse is over.
3879 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3880 was at this position.
3882 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3884 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3885 movement. */
3887 static void
3888 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3889 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3890 Time *timestamp)
3892 FRAME_PTR f1;
3894 BLOCK_INPUT;
3896 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3897 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3898 else
3900 Window root;
3901 int root_x, root_y;
3903 Window dummy_window;
3904 int dummy;
3906 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3908 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3909 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3910 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3911 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3912 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3914 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3916 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3917 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3918 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3920 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3921 &root,
3923 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3924 a different screen. */
3925 &dummy_window,
3927 /* The position on that root window. */
3928 &root_x, &root_y,
3930 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3931 &dummy, &dummy,
3933 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3934 we don't care. */
3935 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3937 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3938 containing the pointer. */
3940 Window win, child;
3941 int win_x, win_y;
3942 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3944 win = root;
3946 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3947 structure is changing at the same time this function
3948 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3950 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3952 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3953 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3955 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3956 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3957 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3959 /* From-window, to-window. */
3960 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3962 /* From-position, to-position. */
3963 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3965 /* Child of win. */
3966 &child);
3967 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3969 else
3971 while (1)
3973 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3975 /* From-window, to-window. */
3976 root, win,
3978 /* From-position, to-position. */
3979 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3981 /* Child of win. */
3982 &child);
3984 if (child == None || child == win)
3985 break;
3986 #ifdef USE_GTK
3987 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3988 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3989 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3990 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3991 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3992 break;
3993 #endif
3994 win = child;
3995 parent_x = win_x;
3996 parent_y = win_y;
3999 /* Now we know that:
4000 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4001 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4002 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4003 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4004 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4005 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4006 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4007 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4008 never use them in that case.) */
4010 #ifdef USE_GTK
4011 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4012 want the edit window. */
4013 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4014 #else
4015 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4016 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4017 #endif
4019 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4020 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4021 on the frame. */
4022 if (f1 != NULL
4023 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4024 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4025 f1 = NULL;
4026 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4029 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4030 f1 = 0;
4032 x_uncatch_errors ();
4034 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4035 if (! f1)
4037 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4039 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4041 if (bar)
4043 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4044 win_x = parent_x;
4045 win_y = parent_y;
4049 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4050 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4052 if (f1)
4054 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4055 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4056 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4057 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4058 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4059 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4060 the frame are divided into. */
4062 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4063 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4065 *bar_window = Qnil;
4066 *part = 0;
4067 *fp = f1;
4068 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4069 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4070 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4075 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4080 /***********************************************************************
4081 Scroll bars
4082 ***********************************************************************/
4084 /* Scroll bar support. */
4086 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4087 manages it.
4088 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4089 bits. */
4091 static struct scroll_bar *
4092 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4094 Lisp_Object tail;
4096 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4097 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4098 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4100 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4102 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4104 frame = XCAR (tail);
4105 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4106 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4107 abort ();
4109 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4110 continue;
4112 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4113 right window ID. */
4114 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4115 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4116 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4117 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4118 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4119 condemned = Qnil,
4120 ! NILP (bar));
4121 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4122 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4123 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4124 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4127 return NULL;
4131 #if defined USE_LUCID
4133 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4134 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4136 static Widget
4137 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4139 Lisp_Object tail;
4141 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4143 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4145 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4146 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4148 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4149 return menu_bar;
4153 return NULL;
4156 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4159 /************************************************************************
4160 Toolkit scroll bars
4161 ************************************************************************/
4163 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4165 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4166 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4167 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4168 struct scroll_bar *);
4169 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4170 int, int, int);
4173 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4174 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4176 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4178 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4180 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4182 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4183 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4185 #ifndef USE_GTK
4186 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4188 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4190 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4192 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4193 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4194 to avoid jerkiness. */
4196 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4198 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4199 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4200 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4201 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4203 static void
4204 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4205 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4207 int scroll_bar_p;
4208 const char *end_action;
4210 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4211 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4212 end_action = "Release";
4213 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4214 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4215 end_action = "EndScroll";
4216 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4218 if (scroll_bar_p
4219 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4220 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4222 struct window *w;
4224 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4225 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4226 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4228 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4230 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4231 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4232 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4234 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4235 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4237 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4238 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4241 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4243 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4244 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4246 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4247 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4250 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4251 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4252 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4253 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4255 static void
4256 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4258 XEvent event;
4259 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4260 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4261 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4262 ptrdiff_t i;
4264 BLOCK_INPUT;
4266 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4267 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4268 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4269 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4270 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4271 ev->format = 32;
4273 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4274 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4275 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4276 into that array in the event. */
4277 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4278 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4279 break;
4281 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4283 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4284 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4285 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4286 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4287 scroll_bar_windows =
4288 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4289 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4290 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4291 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4294 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4295 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4296 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4297 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4298 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4299 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4301 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4302 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4303 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4304 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4305 #endif
4307 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4308 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4309 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4310 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4311 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4315 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4316 in *IEVENT. */
4318 static void
4319 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4321 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4322 Lisp_Object window;
4323 struct window *w;
4325 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4326 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4328 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4330 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4331 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4332 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4333 #ifdef USE_GTK
4334 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4335 #else
4336 ievent->timestamp =
4337 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4338 #endif
4339 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4340 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4341 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4342 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4343 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4347 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4349 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4351 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4354 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4355 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4356 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4358 static void
4359 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4361 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4362 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4363 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4365 switch (cs->reason)
4367 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4368 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4369 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4370 break;
4372 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4373 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4374 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4375 break;
4377 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4378 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4379 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4380 break;
4382 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4383 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4384 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4385 break;
4387 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4388 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4389 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4390 break;
4392 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4393 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4394 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4395 break;
4397 case XmCR_DRAG:
4399 int slider_size;
4401 /* Get the slider size. */
4402 BLOCK_INPUT;
4403 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4404 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4406 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4407 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4408 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4409 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4411 break;
4413 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4414 break;
4417 if (part >= 0)
4419 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4420 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4421 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4425 #elif defined USE_GTK
4427 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4428 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4430 static gboolean
4431 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4432 GtkScrollType scroll,
4433 gdouble value,
4434 gpointer user_data)
4436 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4437 gdouble position;
4438 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4439 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4440 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4442 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4443 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4446 switch (scroll)
4448 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4449 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4450 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4451 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4453 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4454 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4455 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4456 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4457 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4459 break;
4460 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4461 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4462 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4463 break;
4464 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4465 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4466 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4467 break;
4468 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4469 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4470 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4471 break;
4472 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4473 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4474 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4475 break;
4478 if (part >= 0)
4480 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4481 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4482 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4485 return FALSE;
4488 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4490 static gboolean
4491 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4492 GdkEventButton *event,
4493 gpointer user_data)
4495 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4496 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4497 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4499 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4500 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4501 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4504 return FALSE;
4508 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4510 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4511 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4512 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4513 the thumb is. */
4515 static void
4516 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4518 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4519 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4520 float shown;
4521 int whole, portion, height;
4522 int part;
4524 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4525 BLOCK_INPUT;
4526 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4527 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4529 whole = 10000000;
4530 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4532 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4533 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4534 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4535 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4536 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4537 bottom). */
4538 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4539 else
4540 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4542 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4543 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4544 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4545 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4549 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4550 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4551 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4552 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4553 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4554 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4555 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4557 static void
4558 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4560 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4561 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4562 int position = (long) call_data;
4563 Dimension height;
4564 int part;
4566 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4567 BLOCK_INPUT;
4568 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4569 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4571 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4572 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4574 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4575 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4576 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4577 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4578 else
4579 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4581 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4582 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4583 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4584 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4587 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4589 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4591 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4592 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4594 #ifdef USE_GTK
4595 static void
4596 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4598 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4600 BLOCK_INPUT;
4601 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4602 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4603 scroll_bar_name);
4604 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4607 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4609 static void
4610 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4612 Window xwindow;
4613 Widget widget;
4614 Arg av[20];
4615 int ac = 0;
4616 char const *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4617 unsigned long pixel;
4619 BLOCK_INPUT;
4621 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4622 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4623 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4624 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4625 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4626 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4627 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4628 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4629 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4631 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4632 if (pixel != -1)
4634 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4635 ++ac;
4638 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4639 if (pixel != -1)
4641 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4642 ++ac;
4645 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4646 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4648 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4649 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4650 (XtPointer) bar);
4651 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4652 (XtPointer) bar);
4653 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4654 (XtPointer) bar);
4655 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4656 (XtPointer) bar);
4657 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4658 (XtPointer) bar);
4659 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4660 (XtPointer) bar);
4661 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4662 (XtPointer) bar);
4664 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4665 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4667 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4668 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4669 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4670 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4672 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4674 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4675 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4676 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4677 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4678 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4679 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4680 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4681 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4683 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4684 if (pixel != -1)
4686 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4687 ++ac;
4690 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4691 if (pixel != -1)
4693 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4694 ++ac;
4697 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4699 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4700 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4702 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4703 if (pixel != -1)
4705 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4706 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4707 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4708 pixel = -1;
4709 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4712 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4714 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4715 if (pixel != -1)
4717 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4718 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4719 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4720 pixel = -1;
4721 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4725 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4726 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4727 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4728 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4729 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4730 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4731 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4732 colors itself. */
4734 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4735 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4736 ++ac;
4738 else
4739 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4740 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4741 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4743 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4744 the shadows. */
4745 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4746 ++ac;
4748 /* Specify the colors. */
4749 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4750 if (pixel != -1)
4752 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4753 ++ac;
4755 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4756 if (pixel != -1)
4758 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4759 ++ac;
4762 #endif
4764 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4765 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4768 char const *initial = "";
4769 char const *val = initial;
4770 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4771 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4772 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4773 #endif
4774 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4775 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4776 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4777 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4778 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4779 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4783 /* Define callbacks. */
4784 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4785 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4786 (XtPointer) bar);
4788 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4789 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4791 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4793 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4794 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4795 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4796 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4798 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4799 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4800 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4801 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4803 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4805 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4808 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4809 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4811 #ifdef USE_GTK
4812 static void
4813 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4815 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4818 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4819 static void
4820 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4821 int whole)
4823 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4824 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4825 float top, shown;
4827 BLOCK_INPUT;
4829 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4831 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4832 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4833 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4834 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4835 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4836 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4837 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4838 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4839 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4840 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4841 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4842 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4843 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4844 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4845 whole += portion;
4847 if (whole <= 0)
4848 top = 0, shown = 1;
4849 else
4851 top = (float) position / whole;
4852 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4855 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4857 int size, value;
4859 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4860 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4861 value. */
4862 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4863 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4864 size = max (size, 1);
4866 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4867 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4868 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4870 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4872 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4874 if (whole == 0)
4875 top = 0, shown = 1;
4876 else
4878 top = (float) position / whole;
4879 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4883 float old_top, old_shown;
4884 Dimension height;
4885 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4886 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4887 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4888 XtNheight, &height,
4889 NULL);
4891 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4892 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4893 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4894 else
4895 top = old_top;
4896 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4897 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4899 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4900 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4901 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4902 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4904 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4905 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4906 else
4908 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4909 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4910 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4912 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4916 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4918 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4920 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4922 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4926 /************************************************************************
4927 Scroll bars, general
4928 ************************************************************************/
4930 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4931 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4932 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4933 scroll bar. */
4935 static struct scroll_bar *
4936 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4938 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4939 struct scroll_bar *bar
4940 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4942 BLOCK_INPUT;
4944 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4945 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4946 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4948 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4949 unsigned long mask;
4950 Window window;
4952 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4953 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4954 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4956 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4957 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4958 | ExposureMask);
4959 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4961 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4963 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4964 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4965 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4966 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4967 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4968 left, top, width,
4969 window_box_height (w), False);
4971 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4972 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4973 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4974 top,
4975 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4976 height,
4977 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4979 CopyFromParent,
4980 CopyFromParent,
4981 CopyFromParent,
4982 /* Attributes. */
4983 mask, &a);
4984 bar->x_window = window;
4986 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4988 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4989 bar->top = top;
4990 bar->left = left;
4991 bar->width = width;
4992 bar->height = height;
4993 bar->start = 0;
4994 bar->end = 0;
4995 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4996 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4998 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4999 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5000 bar->prev = Qnil;
5001 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5002 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5003 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5005 /* Map the window/widget. */
5006 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5008 #ifdef USE_GTK
5009 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5010 bar->x_window,
5011 top,
5012 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5013 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5014 max (height, 1));
5015 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5016 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5017 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5018 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5019 top,
5020 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5021 max (height, 1), 0);
5022 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5023 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5025 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5026 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5027 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5029 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5030 return bar;
5034 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5036 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5038 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5039 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5040 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5041 events.)
5043 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5044 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5045 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5046 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5047 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5049 static void
5050 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5052 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5053 Window w = bar->x_window;
5054 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5055 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5057 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5058 if (! rebuild
5059 && start == bar->start
5060 && end == bar->end)
5061 return;
5063 BLOCK_INPUT;
5066 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5067 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5068 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5070 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5071 the distance between start and end. */
5073 int length = end - start;
5075 if (start < 0)
5076 start = 0;
5077 else if (start > top_range)
5078 start = top_range;
5079 end = start + length;
5081 if (end < start)
5082 end = start;
5083 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5084 end = top_range;
5087 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5088 bar->start = start;
5089 bar->end = end;
5091 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5092 if (end > top_range)
5093 end = top_range;
5095 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5096 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5097 that many pixels tall. */
5098 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5100 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5101 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5102 if (0 < start)
5103 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5104 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5105 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5106 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5107 inside_width, start,
5108 False);
5110 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5111 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5112 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5113 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5115 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5116 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5117 /* x, y, width, height */
5118 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5119 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5120 inside_width, end - start);
5122 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5123 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5124 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5125 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5127 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5128 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5129 if (end < inside_height)
5130 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5131 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5132 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5133 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5134 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5135 False);
5139 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5142 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5144 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5145 nil. */
5147 static void
5148 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5150 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5151 BLOCK_INPUT;
5153 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5154 #ifdef USE_GTK
5155 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5156 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5157 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5158 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5159 #else
5160 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5161 #endif
5163 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5164 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5166 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5170 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5171 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5172 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5173 create one. */
5175 static void
5176 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5178 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5179 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5180 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5181 int window_y, window_height;
5182 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5183 int fringe_extended_p;
5184 #endif
5186 /* Get window dimensions. */
5187 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5188 top = window_y;
5189 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5190 height = window_height;
5192 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5193 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5195 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5196 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5197 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5198 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5199 else
5200 sb_width = width;
5202 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5203 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5204 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5205 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5206 else
5207 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5208 #else
5209 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5210 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5211 else
5212 sb_left = left;
5213 #endif
5215 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5216 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5217 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5218 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5219 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5220 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5221 else
5222 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5223 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5224 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5225 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5226 #endif
5228 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5229 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5231 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5233 BLOCK_INPUT;
5234 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5235 if (fringe_extended_p)
5236 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5237 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5238 else
5239 #endif
5240 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5241 left, top, width, height, False);
5242 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5245 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5247 else
5249 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5250 unsigned int mask = 0;
5252 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5254 BLOCK_INPUT;
5256 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5257 mask |= CWX;
5258 if (top != bar->top)
5259 mask |= CWY;
5260 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5261 mask |= CWWidth;
5262 if (height != bar->height)
5263 mask |= CWHeight;
5265 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5267 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5268 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5270 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5271 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5272 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5274 if (fringe_extended_p)
5275 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5276 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5277 else
5278 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5279 left, top, width, height, False);
5281 #ifdef USE_GTK
5282 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5283 bar->x_window,
5284 top,
5285 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5286 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5287 max (height, 1));
5288 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5289 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5290 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5291 top,
5292 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5293 max (height, 1), 0);
5294 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5296 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5298 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5299 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5300 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5302 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5303 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5304 height, False);
5305 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5306 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5307 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5308 height, False);
5311 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5312 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5313 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5314 example. */
5316 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5317 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5318 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5320 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5321 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5322 left + area_width - rest, top,
5323 rest, height, False);
5324 else
5325 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5326 left, top, rest, height, False);
5330 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5331 if (mask)
5333 XWindowChanges wc;
5335 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5336 wc.y = top;
5337 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5338 wc.height = height;
5339 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5340 mask, &wc);
5343 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5345 /* Remember new settings. */
5346 bar->left = sb_left;
5347 bar->top = top;
5348 bar->width = sb_width;
5349 bar->height = height;
5351 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5354 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5355 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5357 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5358 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5359 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5360 dragged. */
5361 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5363 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5365 if (whole == 0)
5366 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5367 else
5369 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5370 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5371 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5374 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5376 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5380 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5381 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5382 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5383 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5384 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5385 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5386 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5388 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5389 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5390 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5392 static void
5393 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5395 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5396 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5398 Lisp_Object bar;
5399 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5400 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5401 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5402 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5403 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5404 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5405 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5410 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5411 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5413 static void
5414 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5416 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5417 struct frame *f;
5419 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5420 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5421 abort ();
5423 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5425 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5426 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5427 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5429 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5430 the lists. */
5431 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5432 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5433 return;
5434 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5435 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5436 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5437 else
5438 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5439 one or the other! */
5440 abort ();
5442 else
5443 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5445 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5446 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5448 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5449 bar->prev = Qnil;
5450 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5451 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5452 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5455 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5456 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5458 static void
5459 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5461 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5463 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5465 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5466 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5467 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5469 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5471 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5473 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5475 next = b->next;
5476 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5479 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5480 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5484 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5485 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5486 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5488 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5489 mark bits. */
5491 static void
5492 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5494 Window w = bar->x_window;
5495 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5496 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5497 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5499 BLOCK_INPUT;
5501 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5503 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5504 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5505 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5506 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5508 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5509 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5511 /* x, y, width, height */
5512 0, 0,
5513 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5514 bar->height - 1);
5516 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5517 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5518 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5519 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5521 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5524 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5526 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5527 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5529 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5530 mark bits. */
5533 static void
5534 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5536 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5537 abort ();
5539 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5540 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5541 emacs_event->modifiers
5542 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5543 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5544 event->xbutton.state)
5545 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5546 ? up_modifier
5547 : down_modifier));
5548 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5549 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5550 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5552 int top_range
5553 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5554 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5556 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5557 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5559 if (y < bar->start)
5560 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5561 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5562 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5563 else
5564 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5566 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5567 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5568 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5569 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5571 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5572 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5574 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5575 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5577 #endif
5579 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5580 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5584 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5586 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5588 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5589 mark bits. */
5591 static void
5592 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5594 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5596 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5598 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5599 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5601 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5602 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5604 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5605 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5607 if (new_start != bar->start)
5609 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5611 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5616 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5618 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5619 on the scroll bar. */
5621 static void
5622 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5623 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5624 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5626 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5627 Window w = bar->x_window;
5628 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5629 int win_x, win_y;
5630 Window dummy_window;
5631 int dummy_coord;
5632 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5634 BLOCK_INPUT;
5636 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5637 report that. */
5638 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5640 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5641 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5642 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5644 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5645 &win_x, &win_y,
5647 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5648 &dummy_mask))
5650 else
5652 int top_range
5653 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5655 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5657 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5658 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5660 if (win_y < 0)
5661 win_y = 0;
5662 if (win_y > top_range)
5663 win_y = top_range;
5665 *fp = f;
5666 *bar_window = bar->window;
5668 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5669 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5670 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5671 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5672 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5673 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5674 else
5675 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5677 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5678 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5680 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5681 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5684 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5686 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5690 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5691 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5692 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5693 redraw them. */
5695 static void
5696 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5698 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5699 Lisp_Object bar;
5701 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5702 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5703 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5704 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5705 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5706 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5707 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5708 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5709 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5710 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5714 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5716 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5717 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5718 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5719 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5721 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5722 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5724 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5726 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5727 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5729 static int temp_index;
5730 static short temp_buffer[100];
5732 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5733 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5734 temp_index = 0; \
5735 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5737 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5738 on a particular display. */
5740 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5742 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5743 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5744 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5745 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5747 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5749 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5750 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5751 do \
5753 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5754 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5755 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5756 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5757 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5758 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5760 while (0)
5761 #endif
5763 enum
5765 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5766 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5767 X_EVENT_DROP
5770 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5771 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5772 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5774 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5775 this event further.
5776 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5778 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5779 static int
5780 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5782 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5783 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5784 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5785 was created. */
5787 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5788 event->xclient.window);
5790 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5792 #endif
5794 #ifdef USE_GTK
5795 static int current_count;
5796 static int current_finish;
5797 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5799 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5800 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5801 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5802 static GdkFilterReturn
5803 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5805 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5807 BLOCK_INPUT;
5808 if (current_count >= 0)
5810 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5812 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5814 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5815 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5816 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5817 so we do it here. */
5818 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5819 && dpyinfo
5820 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5822 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5823 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5825 #endif
5827 if (! dpyinfo)
5828 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5829 else
5830 current_count +=
5831 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5832 current_hold_quit);
5834 else
5835 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5837 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5839 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5840 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5842 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5844 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5847 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5848 enum xembed_message,
5849 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5851 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5853 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5854 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5855 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5857 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5859 static int
5860 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5861 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5863 union {
5864 struct input_event ie;
5865 struct selection_input_event sie;
5866 } inev;
5867 int count = 0;
5868 int do_help = 0;
5869 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5870 struct frame *f = NULL;
5871 struct coding_system coding;
5872 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5873 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5874 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5876 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5878 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5879 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5880 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5882 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5883 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5885 switch (event.type)
5887 case ClientMessage:
5889 if (event.xclient.message_type
5890 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5891 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5893 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5894 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5896 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5897 could be the shell widget window
5898 if the frame has no title bar. */
5899 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5900 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5901 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5902 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5903 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5904 #endif
5905 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5906 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5907 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5908 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5909 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5910 needed.
5912 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5913 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5914 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5915 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5916 Emacs. */
5918 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5919 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5920 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5921 if (f)
5923 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5924 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5925 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5926 x_catch_errors (d);
5927 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5928 /* The ICCCM says this is
5929 the only valid choice. */
5930 RevertToParent,
5931 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5932 /* This is needed to detect the error
5933 if there is an error. */
5934 XSync (d, False);
5935 x_uncatch_errors ();
5937 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5938 #endif /* 0 */
5939 goto done;
5942 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5943 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5945 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5946 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5947 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5948 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5949 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5950 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5951 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5952 session manager and one for this. */
5953 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5954 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5955 #endif
5957 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5958 event.xclient.window);
5959 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5960 for a single Emacs process. */
5961 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5962 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5963 event.xclient.window,
5964 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5965 else if (f)
5966 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5967 event.xclient.window,
5968 0, 0);
5970 goto done;
5973 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5974 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5976 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5977 event.xclient.window);
5978 if (!f)
5979 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5981 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5982 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5983 goto done;
5986 goto done;
5989 if (event.xclient.message_type
5990 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5992 goto done;
5995 if (event.xclient.message_type
5996 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5998 int new_x, new_y;
5999 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6001 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6002 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6004 if (f)
6006 f->left_pos = new_x;
6007 f->top_pos = new_y;
6009 goto done;
6012 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6013 if (event.xclient.message_type
6014 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6016 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6017 if (f)
6018 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6019 &event, NULL);
6020 goto done;
6022 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6024 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6025 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6026 || (event.xclient.message_type
6027 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6029 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6030 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6031 currently never do because we are interested in
6032 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6033 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6034 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6035 if (!f)
6036 goto OTHER;
6037 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6038 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6039 goto done;
6042 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6043 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6044 we construct an input_event. */
6045 if (event.xclient.message_type
6046 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6048 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6049 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6050 goto done;
6052 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6054 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6055 if (event.xclient.message_type
6056 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6058 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6059 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6060 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6062 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6063 goto done;
6066 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6068 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6069 if (!f)
6070 goto OTHER;
6071 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6072 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6074 break;
6076 case SelectionNotify:
6077 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6078 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6079 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6080 goto OTHER;
6081 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6082 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6083 break;
6085 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6086 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6087 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6088 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6089 goto OTHER;
6090 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6092 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6094 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6095 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6096 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6097 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6098 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6100 break;
6102 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6103 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6104 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6105 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6106 goto OTHER;
6107 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6109 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6111 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6112 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6113 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6114 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6115 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6116 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6117 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6118 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6120 break;
6122 case PropertyNotify:
6123 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6124 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6125 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6126 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6127 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6129 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6130 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6131 treat it as deiconified. */
6132 if (! f->async_iconified)
6133 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6134 f->async_visible = 1;
6135 f->async_iconified = 0;
6136 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6137 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6138 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6139 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6142 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6143 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6144 goto OTHER;
6146 case ReparentNotify:
6147 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6148 if (f)
6150 int x, y;
6151 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6152 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6153 f->left_pos = x;
6154 f->top_pos = y;
6156 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6157 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6158 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6160 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6162 goto OTHER;
6164 case Expose:
6165 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6166 if (f)
6168 #ifdef USE_GTK
6169 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6170 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6171 event.xexpose.window,
6172 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6173 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6174 FALSE);
6175 #endif
6176 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6178 f->async_visible = 1;
6179 f->async_iconified = 0;
6180 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6181 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6183 else
6184 expose_frame (f,
6185 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6186 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6188 else
6190 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6191 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6192 #endif
6193 #if defined USE_LUCID
6194 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6195 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6196 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6198 Widget widget
6199 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6200 if (widget)
6201 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6203 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6205 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6206 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6207 goto OTHER;
6208 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6209 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6210 event.xexpose.window);
6212 if (bar)
6213 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6214 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6215 else
6216 goto OTHER;
6217 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6218 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6220 break;
6222 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6223 source area was obscured or not
6224 available. */
6225 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6226 if (f)
6228 expose_frame (f,
6229 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6230 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6231 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6233 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6234 else
6235 goto OTHER;
6236 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6237 break;
6239 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6240 source area was completely
6241 available. */
6242 break;
6244 case UnmapNotify:
6245 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6246 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6248 tip_window = 0;
6249 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6252 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6253 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6254 the frame was deleted. */
6256 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6257 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6258 display that won't ever be seen. */
6259 f->async_visible = 0;
6260 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6261 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6262 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6263 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6264 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6265 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6266 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6268 f->async_iconified = 1;
6270 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6271 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6274 goto OTHER;
6276 case MapNotify:
6277 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6278 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6279 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6280 goto OTHER;
6282 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6283 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6284 frame is visible. */
6285 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6286 if (f)
6288 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6289 the frame's display structures.
6290 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6291 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6292 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6293 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6294 if (! f->async_iconified)
6295 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6297 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6298 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6299 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6300 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6302 f->async_visible = 1;
6303 f->async_iconified = 0;
6304 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6306 if (f->iconified)
6308 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6309 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6311 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6312 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6313 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6314 to update the frame titles
6315 in case this is the second frame. */
6316 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6318 #ifdef USE_GTK
6319 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6320 #endif
6322 goto OTHER;
6324 case KeyPress:
6326 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6327 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6329 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6330 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6331 if (popup_activated ())
6332 goto OTHER;
6333 #endif
6335 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6337 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6338 mouse highlighting. */
6339 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6340 && (f == 0
6341 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6343 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6344 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6347 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6348 if (f == 0)
6350 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6351 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6352 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6353 event.xkey.window);
6354 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6356 widget = XtParent (widget);
6357 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6360 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6362 if (f != 0)
6364 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6365 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6366 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6367 his Emacs hang.
6369 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6370 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6371 status_return even if the input is too long to
6372 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6373 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6374 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6375 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6376 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6377 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6378 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6379 int modifiers;
6380 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6381 Lisp_Object c;
6383 #ifdef USE_GTK
6384 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6385 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6386 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6387 (see above). */
6388 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6389 #endif
6391 event.xkey.state
6392 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6393 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6394 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6396 /* This will have to go some day... */
6398 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6399 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6400 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6401 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6402 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6403 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6404 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6406 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6407 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6408 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6409 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6410 not it is combined with Meta. */
6411 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6412 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6414 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6415 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6417 Status status_return;
6419 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6420 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6421 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6422 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6423 &status_return);
6424 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6426 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6427 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6428 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6429 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6430 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6431 &status_return);
6433 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6434 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6435 break;
6436 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6438 keysym = NoSymbol;
6439 modifiers = 0;
6441 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6442 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6443 abort ();
6445 else
6446 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6447 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6448 &compose_status);
6449 #else
6450 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6451 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6452 &compose_status);
6453 #endif
6455 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6456 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6457 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6458 break;
6460 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6461 orig_keysym = keysym;
6463 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6464 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6465 inev.ie.modifiers
6466 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6467 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6469 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6470 translations to characters. */
6471 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6472 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6474 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6475 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6476 goto done_keysym;
6479 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6480 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6482 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6483 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6484 else
6485 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6486 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6487 goto done_keysym;
6490 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6491 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6492 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6493 Vx_keysym_table,
6494 Qnil),
6495 NATNUMP (c)))
6497 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6498 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6499 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6500 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6501 goto done_keysym;
6504 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6505 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6506 || keysym == XK_Delete
6507 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6508 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6509 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6510 #endif
6511 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6512 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6513 #ifdef HPUX
6514 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6515 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6516 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6517 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6518 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6519 #endif
6520 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6521 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6522 #endif
6523 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6524 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6525 #endif
6526 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6527 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6528 #endif
6529 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6530 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6531 #endif
6532 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6533 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6534 #endif
6535 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6536 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6537 #endif
6538 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6539 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6540 #endif
6541 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6542 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6543 #endif
6544 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6545 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6546 #endif
6547 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6548 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6549 #endif
6550 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6551 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6552 #endif
6553 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6554 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6555 #endif
6556 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6557 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6558 #endif
6559 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6560 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6561 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6562 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6563 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6564 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6565 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6566 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6567 don't have real modifiers but
6568 should be treated similarly to
6569 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6570 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6571 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6572 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6573 #endif
6576 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6577 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6578 key. */
6579 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6580 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6581 goto done_keysym;
6584 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6585 ptrdiff_t i;
6586 int nchars, len;
6588 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6590 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6591 nchars++;
6592 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6595 if (nchars < nbytes)
6597 /* Decode the input data. */
6599 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6600 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6601 we used just above and the locale. */
6602 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6603 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6604 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6605 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6606 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6607 gives us composition information. */
6608 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6610 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6611 nbytes);
6612 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6613 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6614 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6615 nbytes = coding.produced;
6616 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6617 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6620 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6621 character events. */
6622 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6624 int ch;
6625 if (nchars == nbytes)
6626 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6627 else
6628 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6629 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6630 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6631 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6632 inev.ie.code = ch;
6633 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6636 count += nchars;
6638 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6640 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6641 break;
6644 done_keysym:
6645 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6646 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6647 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6648 client. */
6649 break;
6650 #else
6651 goto OTHER;
6652 #endif
6654 case KeyRelease:
6655 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6656 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6657 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6658 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6659 client. */
6660 break;
6661 #else
6662 goto OTHER;
6663 #endif
6665 case EnterNotify:
6666 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6667 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6669 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6671 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6672 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6674 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6675 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6676 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6677 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6678 #ifdef USE_GTK
6679 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6680 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6681 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6682 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6683 #endif
6684 goto OTHER;
6686 case FocusIn:
6687 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6688 goto OTHER;
6690 case LeaveNotify:
6691 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6692 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6694 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6695 if (f)
6697 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6699 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6700 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6701 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6702 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6705 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6706 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6707 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6708 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6709 if (any_help_event_p)
6710 do_help = -1;
6712 #ifdef USE_GTK
6713 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6714 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6715 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6716 #endif
6717 goto OTHER;
6719 case FocusOut:
6720 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6721 goto OTHER;
6723 case MotionNotify:
6725 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6726 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6727 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6729 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6730 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6731 f = last_mouse_frame;
6732 else
6733 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6735 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6737 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6738 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6741 #ifdef USE_GTK
6742 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6743 f = 0;
6744 #endif
6745 if (f)
6748 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6749 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6750 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6752 Lisp_Object window;
6754 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6755 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6756 0, 0);
6758 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6759 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6760 will be selected only when it is active. */
6761 if (WINDOWP (window)
6762 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6763 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6764 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6765 create event iff we don't leave the
6766 selected frame. */
6767 && (focus_follows_mouse
6768 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6769 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6771 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6772 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6775 last_window=window;
6777 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6778 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6780 else
6782 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6783 struct scroll_bar *bar
6784 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6785 event.xmotion.window);
6787 if (bar)
6788 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6789 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6791 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6792 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6793 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6796 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6797 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6798 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6799 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6800 do_help = 1;
6801 goto OTHER;
6804 case ConfigureNotify:
6805 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6806 #ifdef USE_GTK
6807 if (!f
6808 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6809 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6811 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6812 event.xconfigure.height);
6813 f = 0;
6815 #endif
6816 if (f)
6818 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6819 #ifndef USE_GTK
6820 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6821 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6823 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6824 is called by the code that handles resizing
6825 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6827 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6828 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6829 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6830 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6831 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6832 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6833 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6835 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6836 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6837 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6840 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6841 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6842 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6843 #endif
6845 #ifdef USE_GTK
6846 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6847 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6848 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6849 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6850 #endif
6852 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6855 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6856 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6857 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6858 #endif
6861 goto OTHER;
6863 case ButtonRelease:
6864 case ButtonPress:
6866 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6867 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6868 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6870 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6871 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6872 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6874 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6875 && last_mouse_frame
6876 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6877 f = last_mouse_frame;
6878 else
6879 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6881 #ifdef USE_GTK
6882 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6883 f = 0;
6884 #endif
6885 if (f)
6887 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6888 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6889 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6891 Lisp_Object window;
6892 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6893 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6895 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6896 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6898 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6900 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6901 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6902 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6903 event.xbutton.state));
6907 if (!tool_bar_p)
6908 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6909 if (! popup_activated ())
6910 #endif
6912 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6914 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6915 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6917 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6918 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6920 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6921 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6923 else
6924 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6926 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6927 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6928 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6930 else
6932 struct scroll_bar *bar
6933 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6934 event.xbutton.window);
6936 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6937 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6938 scroll bars. */
6939 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6941 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6942 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6944 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6945 if (bar)
6946 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6947 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6950 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6952 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6953 last_mouse_frame = f;
6955 if (!tool_bar_p)
6956 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6958 else
6959 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6961 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6962 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6963 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6964 if (f != 0)
6965 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6967 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6968 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6969 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6970 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6971 Instead, save it away
6972 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6973 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6974 if (! popup_activated ()
6975 #ifdef USE_GTK
6976 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6977 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6978 #endif
6979 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6980 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6981 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6982 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6983 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6984 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6985 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6986 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6988 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6989 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6990 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6992 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6994 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6995 goto OTHER;
6997 else
6998 goto OTHER;
6999 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7001 break;
7003 case CirculateNotify:
7004 goto OTHER;
7006 case CirculateRequest:
7007 goto OTHER;
7009 case VisibilityNotify:
7010 goto OTHER;
7012 case MappingNotify:
7013 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7014 local cache. */
7015 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7017 case MappingModifier:
7018 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7019 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7020 case MappingKeyboard:
7021 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7023 goto OTHER;
7025 case DestroyNotify:
7026 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7027 break;
7029 default:
7030 OTHER:
7031 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7032 BLOCK_INPUT;
7033 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7034 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7035 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7036 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7037 break;
7040 done:
7041 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7043 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7044 count++;
7047 if (do_help
7048 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7050 Lisp_Object frame;
7052 if (f)
7053 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7054 else
7055 frame = Qnil;
7057 if (do_help > 0)
7059 any_help_event_p = 1;
7060 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7061 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7063 else
7065 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7066 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7068 count++;
7071 SAFE_FREE ();
7072 *eventptr = event;
7073 return count;
7076 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7078 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7079 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7080 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7082 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7084 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7086 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7087 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7089 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7091 if (dpyinfo)
7092 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7094 return finish;
7096 #endif
7099 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7100 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler only if SYNC_INPUT is
7101 not defined.
7102 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7104 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7105 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7106 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7107 C chars).
7109 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7111 static int
7112 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7114 int count = 0;
7115 int event_found = 0;
7117 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7119 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7120 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7121 pending_signals = 1;
7122 #endif
7123 return -1;
7126 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7127 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7128 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7129 #endif
7130 BLOCK_INPUT;
7132 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7133 input_signal_count++;
7135 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7136 ++handling_signal;
7137 #endif
7139 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7140 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7142 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7143 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7146 #ifndef USE_GTK
7147 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7149 int finish;
7150 XEvent event;
7152 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7154 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7155 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7156 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7157 continue;
7158 #endif
7159 event_found = 1;
7161 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7162 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7164 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7165 goto out;
7168 out:;
7170 #else /* USE_GTK */
7172 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7173 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7174 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7175 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7177 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7178 from all displays. */
7180 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7182 current_count = count;
7183 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7185 gtk_main_iteration ();
7187 count = current_count;
7188 current_count = -1;
7189 current_hold_quit = 0;
7191 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7192 break;
7194 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7196 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7197 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7198 if (! event_found)
7200 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7201 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7202 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7203 x_noop_count++;
7204 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7206 x_noop_count=0;
7208 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7209 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7211 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7213 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7214 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7218 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7219 raise it now. */
7220 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7221 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7223 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7224 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7227 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7228 --handling_signal;
7229 #endif
7230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7232 return count;
7238 /***********************************************************************
7239 Text Cursor
7240 ***********************************************************************/
7242 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7243 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7245 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7246 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7247 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7249 static void
7250 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7252 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7253 XRectangle clip_rect;
7254 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7256 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7258 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7259 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7260 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7261 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7262 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7264 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7268 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7270 static void
7271 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7273 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7274 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7275 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7276 int x, y, wd, h;
7277 XGCValues xgcv;
7278 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7279 GC gc;
7281 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7282 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7283 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7284 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7285 return;
7287 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7288 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7289 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7291 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7292 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7293 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7294 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7295 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7296 else
7297 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7298 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7299 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7301 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7302 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7303 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7304 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7308 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7310 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7311 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7312 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7313 --gerd. */
7315 static void
7316 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7318 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7319 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7321 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7322 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7323 and mini-buffer. */
7324 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7325 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7326 return;
7328 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7329 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7330 the bar might not be in the window. */
7331 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7333 struct glyph_row *r;
7334 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7335 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7337 else
7339 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7340 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7341 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7342 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7343 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7344 XGCValues xgcv;
7346 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7347 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7348 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7349 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7350 that the glyph is legible. */
7351 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7352 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7353 else
7354 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7355 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7357 if (gc)
7358 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7359 else
7361 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7362 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7365 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7367 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7369 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7371 if (width < 0)
7372 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7373 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7375 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7377 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7378 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7379 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7380 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7382 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7383 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7384 width, row->height);
7386 else
7388 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7390 if (width < 0)
7391 width = row->height;
7393 width = min (row->height, width);
7395 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7396 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7398 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7399 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7400 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7401 row->height - width),
7402 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7405 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7410 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7412 static void
7413 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7415 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7416 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7417 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7418 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7422 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7424 static void
7425 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7427 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7428 x, y, width, height, False);
7429 #ifdef USE_GTK
7430 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7431 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7432 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7433 #endif
7437 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7439 static void
7440 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7442 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7444 if (on_p)
7446 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7447 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7449 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7450 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7451 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7452 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7454 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7455 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7457 else
7459 switch (cursor_type)
7461 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7462 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7463 break;
7465 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7466 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7467 break;
7469 case BAR_CURSOR:
7470 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7471 break;
7473 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7474 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7475 break;
7477 case NO_CURSOR:
7478 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7479 break;
7481 default:
7482 abort ();
7486 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7487 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7488 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7489 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7490 #endif
7493 #ifndef XFlush
7494 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7495 #endif
7499 /* Icons. */
7501 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7504 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7506 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7508 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7509 return 1;
7511 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7512 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7513 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7514 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7516 if (STRINGP (file))
7518 #ifdef USE_GTK
7519 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7520 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7521 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7522 return 0;
7523 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7524 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7525 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7527 else
7529 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7530 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7532 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7534 #ifdef USE_GTK
7536 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7537 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7538 return 0;
7540 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7542 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7543 if (rc != -1)
7544 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7546 #endif
7548 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7549 if (rc == -1)
7551 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7552 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7553 if (rc == -1)
7554 return 1;
7556 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7557 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7561 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7562 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7563 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7564 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7565 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7567 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7570 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7571 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7573 return 0;
7577 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7578 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7581 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7583 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7584 return 1;
7587 XTextProperty text;
7588 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7589 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7590 text.format = 8;
7591 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7592 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7595 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7596 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7597 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7598 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7600 return 0;
7603 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7605 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7606 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7608 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7609 be called from a signal handler.
7612 struct x_error_message_stack {
7613 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7614 Display *dpy;
7615 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7617 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7619 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7620 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7621 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7623 static void
7624 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7626 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7627 x_error_message->string,
7628 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7631 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7632 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7633 operating on.
7635 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7636 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7637 stored in *x_error_message.
7639 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7640 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7642 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7644 void
7645 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7647 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7649 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7650 XSync (dpy, False);
7652 data->dpy = dpy;
7653 data->string[0] = 0;
7654 data->prev = x_error_message;
7655 x_error_message = data;
7658 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7659 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7661 void
7662 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7664 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7666 BLOCK_INPUT;
7668 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7669 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7670 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7671 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7673 tmp = x_error_message;
7674 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7675 xfree (tmp);
7676 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7679 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7680 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7681 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7683 void
7684 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7686 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7687 XSync (dpy, False);
7689 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7691 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7692 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7693 x_uncatch_errors ();
7694 error (format, string);
7698 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7699 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7702 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7704 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7705 XSync (dpy, False);
7707 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7710 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7712 void
7713 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7715 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7718 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7719 * idea. --lorentey */
7720 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7722 void
7723 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7725 while (x_error_message)
7726 x_uncatch_errors ();
7728 #endif
7730 #if 0
7731 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7732 x_trace_wire (void)
7734 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7736 #endif /* ! 0 */
7739 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7740 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7741 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7742 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7743 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7745 static void
7746 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7747 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7749 #ifdef USG
7750 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7751 must reestablish each time */
7752 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7753 #endif /* USG */
7757 /************************************************************************
7758 Handling X errors
7759 ************************************************************************/
7761 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7763 static char *error_msg;
7765 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7766 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7768 static void
7769 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7771 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7772 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7773 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7775 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7776 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7777 handling_signal = 0;
7779 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7780 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7782 if (dpyinfo)
7784 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7785 frame on it. */
7786 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7787 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7790 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7791 that are on the dead display. */
7792 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7794 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7795 minibuf_frame
7796 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7797 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7798 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7799 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7800 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7801 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7804 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7805 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7806 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7807 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7808 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7809 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7811 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7812 trying to find a replacement. */
7813 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7814 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7817 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7818 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7819 if (dpyinfo)
7821 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7822 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7823 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7824 #ifdef USE_GTK
7825 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7826 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7827 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7828 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7829 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7830 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7831 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7832 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7833 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7834 error_msg);
7835 abort ();
7836 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7838 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7839 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7841 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7842 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7843 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7844 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7845 abort ();
7848 Lisp_Object tmp;
7849 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7850 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7854 if (terminal_list == 0)
7856 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7857 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7858 /* NOTREACHED */
7861 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7862 #ifdef SIGIO
7863 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7864 #endif
7865 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7866 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7868 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7869 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7871 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7872 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7874 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7875 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7876 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7877 error ("%s", error_msg);
7880 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7881 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7882 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7884 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7885 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7887 static int
7888 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7890 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7891 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7892 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7893 && event->minor_code == 0)
7895 return 0;
7897 #endif
7899 if (x_error_message)
7900 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7901 else
7902 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7903 return 0;
7906 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7907 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7908 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7910 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7912 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7913 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7915 static void NO_INLINE
7916 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7918 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7920 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7921 or colors that are not defined. */
7923 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7924 return;
7926 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7927 original error handler. */
7929 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7930 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7931 buf, event->request_code);
7932 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7936 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7937 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7938 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7940 static int
7941 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7943 char buf[256];
7945 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7946 DisplayString (display));
7947 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7948 return 0;
7951 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7953 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7954 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7955 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7956 FONT-OBJECT. */
7958 Lisp_Object
7959 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7961 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7963 if (fontset < 0)
7964 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7965 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7966 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7967 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7968 do. */
7969 return font_object;
7971 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7972 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7973 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7974 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7975 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7977 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7979 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7980 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7982 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7983 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7984 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7986 else
7988 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7989 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7992 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7994 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7995 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7996 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7997 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7998 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8001 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8002 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8003 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8005 BLOCK_INPUT;
8006 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8007 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8009 #endif
8011 return font_object;
8015 /***********************************************************************
8016 X Input Methods
8017 ***********************************************************************/
8019 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8021 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8023 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8024 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8025 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8027 static void
8028 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8030 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8031 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8033 BLOCK_INPUT;
8035 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8036 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8038 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8039 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8041 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8042 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8046 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8047 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8048 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8049 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8052 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8054 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8055 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8056 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8057 #endif
8059 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8060 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8062 static void
8063 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8065 XIM xim;
8067 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8068 if (use_xim)
8070 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8071 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8072 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8073 emacs_class);
8074 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8076 if (xim)
8078 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8079 XIMCallback destroy;
8080 #endif
8082 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8083 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8085 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8086 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8087 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8088 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8089 #endif
8093 else
8094 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8095 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8099 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8101 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8102 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8103 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8104 when the callback was registered. */
8106 static void
8107 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8109 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8110 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8112 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8113 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8114 return;
8116 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8118 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8119 as they have no XIC. */
8120 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8122 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8124 BLOCK_INPUT;
8125 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8127 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8129 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8130 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8131 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8133 create_frame_xic (f);
8134 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8135 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8136 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8138 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8139 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8144 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8148 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8151 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8152 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8153 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8154 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8156 static void
8157 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8159 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8160 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8161 if (use_xim)
8163 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8164 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8165 ptrdiff_t len;
8167 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8168 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8169 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8170 len = strlen (resource_name);
8171 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8172 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8173 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8174 resource_name, emacs_class,
8175 xim_instantiate_callback,
8176 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8177 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8178 least, hence the configure test. */
8179 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8180 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8181 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8182 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8184 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8188 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8190 static void
8191 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8193 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8194 if (use_xim)
8196 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8197 if (dpyinfo->display)
8198 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8199 NULL, emacs_class,
8200 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8201 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8202 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8203 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8204 if (dpyinfo->display)
8205 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8206 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8207 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8209 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8212 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8216 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8217 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8219 static void
8220 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8222 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8224 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8225 is already for the top-left corner. */
8226 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8227 return;
8229 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8230 position that fits on the screen. */
8231 if (flags & XNegative)
8232 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8233 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8236 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8238 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8239 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8240 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8242 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8243 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8244 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8245 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8246 is right, though.
8248 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8249 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8251 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8252 #endif
8254 if (flags & YNegative)
8255 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8256 - height + f->top_pos;
8259 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8260 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8261 so the flags should correspond. */
8262 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8265 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8266 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8267 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8268 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8269 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8271 void
8272 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8274 int modified_top, modified_left;
8276 if (change_gravity > 0)
8278 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8279 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8281 f->top_pos = yoff;
8282 f->left_pos = xoff;
8283 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8284 if (xoff < 0)
8285 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8286 if (yoff < 0)
8287 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8288 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8290 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8292 BLOCK_INPUT;
8293 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8295 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8296 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8298 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8300 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8301 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8302 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8303 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8304 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8307 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8308 modified_left, modified_top);
8310 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8311 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8312 ? 1 : 0);
8314 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8315 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8316 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8317 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8318 of the frame.
8320 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8321 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8322 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8324 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8325 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8326 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8327 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8328 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8329 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8331 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8334 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8335 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8336 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8337 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8338 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8340 static int
8341 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8343 Atom actual_type;
8344 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8345 int i, rc, actual_format;
8346 Window wmcheck_window;
8347 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8348 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8349 long max_len = 65536;
8350 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8351 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8352 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8354 BLOCK_INPUT;
8356 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8357 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8358 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8359 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8360 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8361 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8363 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8365 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8366 x_uncatch_errors ();
8367 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8368 return 0;
8371 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8372 XFree (tmp_data);
8374 /* Check if window exists. */
8375 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8376 x_sync (f);
8377 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8379 x_uncatch_errors ();
8380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8381 return 0;
8384 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8386 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8387 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8388 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8389 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8390 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8391 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8393 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8394 tmp_data = NULL;
8395 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8396 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8397 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8398 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8399 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8401 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8403 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8404 x_uncatch_errors ();
8405 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8406 return 0;
8409 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8410 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8411 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8414 rc = 0;
8416 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8417 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8419 x_uncatch_errors ();
8420 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8422 return rc;
8425 static void
8426 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8428 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8430 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8431 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8432 make_number (32),
8433 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8434 Fcons
8435 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8436 Fcons
8437 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8438 value != 0
8439 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8440 : Qnil)));
8443 void
8444 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8446 Lisp_Object frame;
8447 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8449 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8451 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8452 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8455 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8456 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8457 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8459 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8461 static int
8462 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8463 Window window,
8464 int *size_state,
8465 int *sticky)
8467 Atom actual_type;
8468 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8469 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8470 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8471 long max_len = 65536;
8472 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8473 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8474 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8476 *sticky = 0;
8477 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8479 BLOCK_INPUT;
8480 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8481 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8482 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8483 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8484 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8486 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8488 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8489 x_uncatch_errors ();
8490 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8491 return ! f->iconified;
8494 x_uncatch_errors ();
8496 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8498 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8499 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8501 is_hidden = 1;
8502 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8504 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8506 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8507 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8508 else
8509 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8511 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8513 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8514 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8515 else
8516 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8518 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8519 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8520 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8521 *sticky = 1;
8524 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8525 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8526 return ! is_hidden;
8529 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8531 static int
8532 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8534 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8535 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8536 int cur, dummy;
8538 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8540 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8541 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8542 if (!have_net_atom)
8543 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8545 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8547 Lisp_Object frame;
8549 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8551 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8552 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8553 are sent at once. */
8554 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8556 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8557 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8558 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8559 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8560 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8561 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8562 break;
8563 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8564 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8565 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8566 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8567 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8568 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8569 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8570 break;
8571 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8572 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8573 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8574 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8575 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8576 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8577 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8578 break;
8579 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8580 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8581 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8582 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8583 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8584 break;
8585 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8586 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8587 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8588 else
8589 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8590 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8593 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8597 return have_net_atom;
8600 static void
8601 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8603 if (f->async_visible)
8605 BLOCK_INPUT;
8606 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8607 x_sync (f);
8608 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8613 static int
8614 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8616 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8617 Lisp_Object lval;
8618 int sticky = 0;
8619 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8621 lval = Qnil;
8622 switch (value)
8624 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8625 lval = Qfullwidth;
8626 break;
8627 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8628 lval = Qfullheight;
8629 break;
8630 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8631 lval = Qfullboth;
8632 break;
8633 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8634 lval = Qmaximized;
8635 break;
8638 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8639 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8641 return not_hidden;
8644 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8645 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8646 static void
8647 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8649 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8650 return;
8652 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8653 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8655 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8656 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8657 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8659 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8661 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8662 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8664 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8666 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8667 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8668 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8669 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8670 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8671 break;
8672 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8673 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8674 break;
8675 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8676 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8679 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8680 width, height);
8684 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8685 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8686 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8687 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8688 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8689 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8690 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8692 static void
8693 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8695 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8697 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8698 window manager window around the frame. */
8700 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8702 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8704 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8706 int adjusted_left;
8707 int adjusted_top;
8709 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8710 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8711 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8713 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8715 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8716 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8718 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8719 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8721 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8723 else
8724 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8725 frame's position. */
8727 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8731 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8732 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8733 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8734 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8735 of an exact comparison. */
8737 static void
8738 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8740 int count = 0;
8742 while (count++ < 50)
8744 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8746 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8747 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8748 loop. */
8750 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8751 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8753 if (fuzzy)
8755 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8756 pixels. */
8758 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8759 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8760 return;
8762 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8763 return;
8766 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8767 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8769 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8773 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8774 void
8775 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8777 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8779 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8780 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8781 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8783 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8784 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8786 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8787 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8788 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8789 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8790 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8792 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8794 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8795 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8796 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8797 BLOCK_INPUT;
8798 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8800 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8801 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8803 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8804 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8806 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8807 break; /* Timeout */
8809 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8810 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8814 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8815 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8816 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8817 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8819 static void
8820 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8822 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8824 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8825 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8826 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8828 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8830 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8832 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8833 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8834 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8835 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8837 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8838 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8839 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8840 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8843 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8844 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8845 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8846 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8847 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8849 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8850 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8851 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8852 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8854 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8855 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8856 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8857 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8858 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8860 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8861 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8863 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8864 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8865 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8866 if (f->async_visible)
8867 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8868 else
8870 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8871 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8872 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8873 x_sync (f);
8878 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8879 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8880 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8881 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8883 void
8884 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8886 BLOCK_INPUT;
8888 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8890 int r, c;
8892 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8893 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8894 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8895 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8896 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8897 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8898 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8899 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8900 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8901 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8902 is however. */
8903 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8904 #endif
8905 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8906 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8907 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8908 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8909 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8910 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8911 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8914 #ifdef USE_GTK
8915 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8916 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8917 else
8918 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8919 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8921 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8923 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8925 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8926 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8928 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8929 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8930 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8931 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8932 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8934 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8937 /* Mouse warping. */
8939 void
8940 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8942 int pix_x, pix_y;
8944 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8945 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8947 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8948 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8950 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8951 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8953 BLOCK_INPUT;
8955 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8956 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8957 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8960 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8962 void
8963 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8965 BLOCK_INPUT;
8967 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8968 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8969 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8972 /* Raise frame F. */
8974 void
8975 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8977 BLOCK_INPUT;
8978 if (f->async_visible)
8979 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8981 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8982 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8985 /* Lower frame F. */
8987 static void
8988 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8990 if (f->async_visible)
8992 BLOCK_INPUT;
8993 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8994 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8995 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8999 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9001 void
9002 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
9004 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9005 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9006 if (f->async_visible)
9007 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
9008 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
9011 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9013 void
9014 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
9016 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9017 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9019 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9020 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9022 Lisp_Object frame;
9023 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9024 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9025 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9026 make_number (32),
9027 Fcons (make_number (1),
9028 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9029 Qnil)));
9033 static void
9034 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
9036 if (raise_flag)
9037 x_raise_frame (f);
9038 else
9039 x_lower_frame (f);
9042 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9044 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9046 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9048 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9050 static void
9051 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9053 unsigned long data[2];
9054 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9056 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9057 data[1] = flags;
9059 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9060 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9061 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9063 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9065 static void
9066 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9067 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9069 XEvent event;
9071 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9072 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9073 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9074 event.xclient.format = 32;
9075 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9076 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9077 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9078 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9079 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9081 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9082 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9083 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9086 /* Change of visibility. */
9088 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9089 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9090 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9091 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9092 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9093 finishes with it. */
9095 void
9096 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9098 Lisp_Object type;
9099 int original_top, original_left;
9100 int retry_count = 2;
9102 retry:
9104 BLOCK_INPUT;
9106 type = x_icon_type (f);
9107 if (!NILP (type))
9108 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9110 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9112 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9113 call x_set_offset a second time
9114 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9115 before the window gets really visible. */
9116 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9117 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9118 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9119 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9121 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9123 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9124 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9125 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9126 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9127 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9128 else
9130 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9131 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9133 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9134 #ifdef USE_GTK
9135 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9136 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9137 #else
9138 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9139 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9140 else
9141 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9142 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9143 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9146 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9148 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9149 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9150 so that incoming events are handled. */
9152 Lisp_Object frame;
9153 int count;
9154 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9155 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9156 will set it when they are handled. */
9157 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9159 original_left = f->left_pos;
9160 original_top = f->top_pos;
9162 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9163 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9165 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9167 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9168 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9169 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9170 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9172 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9173 because the window manager may choose the position
9174 and we don't want to override it. */
9176 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9177 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9178 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9179 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9180 && previously_visible)
9182 Drawable rootw;
9183 int x, y;
9184 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9186 BLOCK_INPUT;
9188 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9189 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9190 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9191 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9192 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9193 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9194 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9195 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9196 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9198 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9199 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9200 original_left, original_top);
9202 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9205 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9207 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9208 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9209 MapNotify at all.. */
9210 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9211 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9213 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9214 x_sync (f);
9216 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9217 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9218 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9219 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9220 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9221 probably a bug. */
9222 if (input_polling_used ())
9224 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9225 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9226 handler reset it. */
9227 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9228 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9229 poll_for_input_1 ();
9230 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9233 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9234 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9237 /* 2000-09-28: In
9239 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9240 (iconify-frame f)
9241 (raise-frame f))
9243 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9244 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9245 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9246 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9248 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9249 goto retry;
9253 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9255 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9257 void
9258 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9260 Window window;
9262 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9263 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9265 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9266 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9267 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9269 BLOCK_INPUT;
9271 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9272 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9273 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9274 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9275 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9276 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9278 #ifdef USE_GTK
9279 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9280 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9281 else
9282 #else
9283 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9284 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9285 else
9286 #endif
9289 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9290 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9292 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9293 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9297 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9298 just by the event that we get from the server.
9299 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9300 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9301 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9302 f->visible = 0;
9303 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9304 f->async_visible = 0;
9305 f->async_iconified = 0;
9307 x_sync (f);
9309 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9312 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9314 void
9315 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9317 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9318 int result;
9319 #endif
9320 Lisp_Object type;
9322 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9323 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9324 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9326 if (f->async_iconified)
9327 return;
9329 BLOCK_INPUT;
9331 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9333 type = x_icon_type (f);
9334 if (!NILP (type))
9335 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9337 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9338 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9340 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9341 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9343 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9344 f->iconified = 1;
9345 f->visible = 1;
9346 f->async_iconified = 1;
9347 f->async_visible = 0;
9348 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9349 return;
9351 #endif
9353 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9355 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9357 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9358 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9359 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9360 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9361 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9362 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9363 so we have to record it here. */
9364 f->iconified = 1;
9365 f->visible = 1;
9366 f->async_iconified = 1;
9367 f->async_visible = 0;
9368 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9369 return;
9372 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9373 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9374 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9375 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9377 if (!result)
9378 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9380 f->async_iconified = 1;
9381 f->async_visible = 0;
9384 BLOCK_INPUT;
9385 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9386 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9387 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9389 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9390 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9391 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9392 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9393 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9394 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9396 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9397 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9399 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9400 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9402 XEvent msg;
9404 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9405 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9406 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9407 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9408 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9410 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9411 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9412 False,
9413 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9414 &msg))
9416 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9417 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9421 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9422 IconicState. */
9423 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9425 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9427 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9428 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9431 f->async_iconified = 1;
9432 f->async_visible = 0;
9434 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9435 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9436 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9440 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9442 void
9443 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9445 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9446 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9447 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9448 Lisp_Object bar;
9449 struct scroll_bar *b;
9450 #endif
9452 BLOCK_INPUT;
9454 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9455 commands to the X server. */
9456 if (dpyinfo->display)
9458 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9459 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9460 face. */
9461 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9462 free_frame_faces (f);
9464 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9465 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9467 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9468 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9469 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9470 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9471 toolkit scroll bars. */
9472 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9474 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9475 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9477 #endif
9479 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9480 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9481 free_frame_xic (f);
9482 #endif
9484 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9485 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9487 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9488 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9490 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9491 we are using a toolkit. */
9492 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9493 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9495 free_frame_menubar (f);
9496 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9498 #ifdef USE_GTK
9499 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9500 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9502 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9503 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9504 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9506 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9507 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9508 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9509 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9510 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9511 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9513 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9514 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9515 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9516 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9517 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9518 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9519 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9520 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9521 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9522 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9523 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9524 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9525 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9526 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9527 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9529 x_free_gcs (f);
9530 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9533 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9534 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9535 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9537 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9538 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9539 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9540 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9541 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9542 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9544 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9546 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9547 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9548 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9549 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9550 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9551 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9552 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9555 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9559 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9561 static void
9562 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9564 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9566 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9567 commands to the X server. */
9568 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9569 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9571 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9575 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9577 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9578 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9579 that the window now has.
9580 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9581 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9582 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9584 #ifndef USE_GTK
9585 void
9586 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9588 XSizeHints size_hints;
9589 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9591 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9592 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9594 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9595 return;
9597 #endif
9599 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9600 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9602 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9603 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9605 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9606 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9608 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9609 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9610 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9611 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9612 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9613 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9615 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9617 int base_width, base_height;
9618 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9620 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9621 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9623 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9625 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9626 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9627 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9628 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9629 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9631 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9632 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9633 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9635 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9636 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9637 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9638 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9639 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9642 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9643 if (flags)
9645 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9646 goto no_read;
9650 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9651 long supplied_return;
9652 int value;
9654 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9655 &supplied_return);
9657 if (flags)
9658 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9659 else
9661 if (value == 0)
9662 hints.flags = 0;
9663 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9664 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9665 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9666 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9667 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9668 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9669 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9670 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9674 no_read:
9676 #ifdef PWinGravity
9677 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9678 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9680 if (user_position)
9682 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9683 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9685 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9687 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9689 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9691 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9693 static void
9694 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9696 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9697 Arg al[1];
9699 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9700 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9701 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9702 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9704 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9705 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9707 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9708 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9711 static void
9712 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9714 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9716 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9717 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9718 #endif
9720 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9722 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9723 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9724 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9725 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9727 else
9729 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9730 pixmap. */
9731 return;
9735 #ifdef USE_GTK
9737 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9738 return;
9741 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9744 Arg al[1];
9745 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9746 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9747 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9748 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9751 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9753 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9754 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9756 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9759 void
9760 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9762 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9764 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9765 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9766 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9768 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9772 /***********************************************************************
9773 Fonts
9774 ***********************************************************************/
9776 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9778 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9779 font table. */
9781 static void
9782 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9784 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9785 if (font->driver->check)
9786 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9789 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9792 /***********************************************************************
9793 Initialization
9794 ***********************************************************************/
9796 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9797 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9798 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9799 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9801 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9802 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9803 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9805 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9806 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9807 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9808 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9809 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9810 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9811 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9814 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9816 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9818 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9820 static int x_initialized;
9822 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9823 the screen number from the server number. */
9824 static int
9825 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9827 int seen_colon = 0;
9828 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9829 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9830 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9832 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9833 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9834 length_until_period++;
9836 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9837 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9838 name1 += 4;
9839 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9840 name2 += 4;
9841 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9842 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9843 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9844 name1 += system_name_length;
9845 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9846 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9847 name2 += system_name_length;
9848 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9849 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9850 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9851 name1 += length_until_period;
9852 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9853 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9854 name2 += length_until_period;
9856 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9858 if (*name1 == ':')
9859 seen_colon = 1;
9860 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9861 return 1;
9863 return (seen_colon
9864 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9865 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9868 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9869 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9870 to 5. */
9871 static void
9872 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9874 int nr = 0;
9875 int off = 0;
9877 while (!(mask & 1))
9879 off++;
9880 mask >>= 1;
9883 while (mask & 1)
9885 nr++;
9886 mask >>= 1;
9889 *offset = off;
9890 *bits = nr;
9893 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9894 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9897 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9899 int dpy_ok = 1;
9900 Display *dpy;
9902 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9903 if (dpy)
9904 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9905 else
9906 dpy_ok = 0;
9907 return dpy_ok;
9910 #ifdef USE_GTK
9911 static void
9912 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9913 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9915 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9916 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9918 #endif
9920 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9921 the structure that describes the open display.
9922 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9924 struct x_display_info *
9925 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9927 int connection;
9928 Display *dpy;
9929 struct terminal *terminal;
9930 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9931 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9932 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9933 ptrdiff_t lim;
9935 BLOCK_INPUT;
9937 if (!x_initialized)
9939 x_initialize ();
9940 ++x_initialized;
9943 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9944 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9946 #ifdef USE_GTK
9948 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9949 int argc;
9950 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9951 char **argv2 = argv;
9952 guint id;
9954 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9956 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9958 else
9960 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9961 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9963 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9964 argv[argc] = 0;
9966 argc = 0;
9967 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9969 if (! NILP (display_name))
9971 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9972 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9975 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9976 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9978 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9980 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9981 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9983 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9984 putenv (fix_events);
9987 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9988 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9989 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9990 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9992 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9993 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9994 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9996 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9997 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9999 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10000 fixup_locale ();
10001 xg_initialize ();
10003 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10005 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
10006 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10008 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10009 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10011 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10012 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10014 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10015 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10017 #endif
10019 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10020 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10023 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10024 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10025 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10026 errors with X11R5:
10027 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10028 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10029 So let's not use it until R6. */
10030 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10031 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10032 #endif
10035 int argc = 0;
10036 char *argv[3];
10038 argv[0] = "";
10039 argc = 1;
10040 if (xrm_option)
10042 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10043 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10045 turn_on_atimers (0);
10046 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10047 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10048 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10049 &argc, argv);
10050 turn_on_atimers (1);
10052 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10053 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10054 fixup_locale ();
10055 #endif
10058 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10059 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10060 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10061 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10062 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10064 /* Detect failure. */
10065 if (dpy == 0)
10067 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10068 return 0;
10071 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10073 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10074 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10075 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10077 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10080 struct x_display_info *share;
10081 Lisp_Object tail;
10083 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10084 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10085 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10086 SSDATA (display_name)))
10087 break;
10088 if (share)
10089 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10090 else
10092 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10093 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10094 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
10096 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10097 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10098 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10099 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10100 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10102 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10104 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10106 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10107 list of terminals. */
10108 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10109 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10110 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10111 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10113 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10114 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10115 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10116 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10117 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10118 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10119 BLOCK_INPUT;
10120 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10121 terminal_list = terminal;
10122 UNGCPRO;
10125 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10126 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10127 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10128 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10129 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10131 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10134 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10135 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10136 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10138 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10139 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10140 x_display_name_list);
10141 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10143 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10145 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10146 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10147 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10148 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10150 #if 0
10151 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10152 #endif /* ! 0 */
10154 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10155 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10156 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10157 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10158 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10159 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10160 + 2);
10161 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10162 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10164 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10165 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10167 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10168 #ifdef USE_GTK
10169 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10170 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10171 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10173 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10174 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10176 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10177 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10178 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10179 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10180 #else
10181 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10182 #endif
10183 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10184 all versions. */
10185 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10187 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10188 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10189 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10190 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10191 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10192 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10193 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10194 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10195 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10196 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10197 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10198 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10199 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10200 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10201 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10202 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10203 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10204 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10205 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10206 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10207 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10208 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10209 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10210 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10211 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10212 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10213 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10214 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10216 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10217 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10218 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10220 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10222 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10223 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10224 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10225 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10226 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10227 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10230 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10231 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10233 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10235 Lisp_Object value;
10236 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10237 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10238 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10239 Qnil, Qnil);
10240 if (STRINGP (value)
10241 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10242 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10243 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10246 else
10247 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10248 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10250 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10252 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10253 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10254 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10255 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10256 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10257 for example). */
10258 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10259 double d;
10260 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10261 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10263 #endif
10265 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10267 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10268 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10269 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10270 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10271 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10272 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10273 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10274 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10275 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10279 const struct
10281 const char *name;
10282 Atom *atom;
10283 } atom_refs[] = {
10284 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10285 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10286 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10287 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10288 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10289 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10290 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10291 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10292 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10293 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10294 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10295 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10296 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10297 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10298 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10299 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10300 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10301 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10302 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10303 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10304 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10305 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10306 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10307 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10308 /* For properties of font. */
10309 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10310 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10311 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10312 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10313 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10314 /* Ghostscript support. */
10315 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10316 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10317 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10318 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10319 /* EWMH */
10320 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10321 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10322 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10323 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10324 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10325 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10326 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10327 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10328 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10329 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10330 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10331 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10332 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10333 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10334 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10335 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10336 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10337 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10338 /* Session management */
10339 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10340 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10341 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10344 int i;
10345 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10346 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10347 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10348 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10349 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10350 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10352 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10353 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10355 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10356 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10357 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10358 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10360 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10361 False, atoms_return);
10363 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10364 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10366 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10367 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10369 xfree (atom_names);
10370 xfree (atoms_return);
10373 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10374 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10375 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10376 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10378 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10379 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10380 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10382 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10383 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10386 dpyinfo->gray
10387 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10388 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10389 1, 0, 1);
10392 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10393 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10394 #endif
10396 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10398 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10399 if (connection != 0)
10400 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10402 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10403 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10404 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10406 #ifdef SIGIO
10407 if (interrupt_input)
10408 init_sigio (connection);
10409 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10411 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10413 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10414 Font font;
10416 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10417 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10418 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10419 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10420 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10421 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10422 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10423 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10424 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10425 abort ();
10426 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10427 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10428 x_uncatch_errors ();
10430 #endif
10432 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10433 for debugging X code. */
10435 Lisp_Object value;
10436 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10437 build_string ("synchronous"),
10438 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10439 Qnil, Qnil);
10440 if (STRINGP (value)
10441 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10442 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10443 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10447 Lisp_Object value;
10448 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10449 build_string ("useXIM"),
10450 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10451 Qnil, Qnil);
10452 #ifdef USE_XIM
10453 if (STRINGP (value)
10454 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10455 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10456 use_xim = 0;
10457 #else
10458 if (STRINGP (value)
10459 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10460 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10461 use_xim = 1;
10462 #endif
10465 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10466 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10467 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10468 tty. */
10469 if (terminal->id == 1)
10470 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10471 #endif
10473 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10475 return dpyinfo;
10478 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10479 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10481 static void
10482 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10484 struct terminal *t;
10486 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10487 X display. */
10488 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10489 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10491 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10492 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10493 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10494 x_session_close ();
10495 #endif
10496 delete_terminal (t);
10497 break;
10500 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10502 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10503 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10504 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10505 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10506 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10507 else
10509 Lisp_Object tail;
10511 tail = x_display_name_list;
10512 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10514 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10516 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10517 break;
10519 tail = XCDR (tail);
10523 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10524 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10526 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10527 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10528 else
10530 struct x_display_info *tail;
10532 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10533 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10534 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10537 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10538 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10539 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10540 xfree (dpyinfo);
10543 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10545 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10546 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10547 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10548 that slows us down. */
10550 static void
10551 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10553 BLOCK_INPUT;
10554 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10555 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10557 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10558 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10559 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10560 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10562 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10565 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10566 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10567 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10568 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10569 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10570 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10571 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10573 void
10574 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10576 BLOCK_INPUT;
10577 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10579 EMACS_TIME interval;
10581 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10582 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10583 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10585 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10588 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10591 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10593 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10595 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10597 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10598 x_produce_glyphs,
10599 x_write_glyphs,
10600 x_insert_glyphs,
10601 x_clear_end_of_line,
10602 x_scroll_run,
10603 x_after_update_window_line,
10604 x_update_window_begin,
10605 x_update_window_end,
10606 x_cursor_to,
10607 x_flush,
10608 #ifdef XFlush
10609 x_flush,
10610 #else
10611 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10612 #endif
10613 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10614 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10615 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10616 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10617 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10618 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10619 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10620 x_draw_glyph_string,
10621 x_define_frame_cursor,
10622 x_clear_frame_area,
10623 x_draw_window_cursor,
10624 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10625 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10629 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10630 void
10631 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10633 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10635 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10636 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10637 if (!terminal->name)
10638 return;
10640 BLOCK_INPUT;
10641 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10642 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10643 X display. */
10644 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10645 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10646 #endif
10648 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10649 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10650 if (dpyinfo->display)
10652 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10653 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10655 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10656 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10657 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10658 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10660 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10661 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10662 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10663 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10664 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10665 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10666 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10667 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10668 leaks in other situations. */
10669 #if 0
10670 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10671 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10672 #else
10673 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10674 #endif
10675 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10676 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10677 closing all the displays. */
10678 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10679 #endif
10681 #ifdef USE_GTK
10682 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10683 #else
10684 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10685 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10686 #else
10687 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10688 #endif
10689 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10692 /* Mark as dead. */
10693 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10694 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10695 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10698 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10699 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10701 static struct terminal *
10702 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10704 struct terminal *terminal;
10706 terminal = create_terminal ();
10708 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10709 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10710 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10712 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10714 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10715 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10716 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10717 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10718 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10719 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10720 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10721 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10722 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10723 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10724 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10725 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10726 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10727 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10728 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10729 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10730 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10731 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10732 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10733 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10735 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10736 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10738 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10739 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10740 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10741 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10742 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10743 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10744 off the bottom. */
10746 return terminal;
10749 void
10750 x_initialize (void)
10752 baud_rate = 19200;
10754 x_noop_count = 0;
10755 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10756 any_help_event_p = 0;
10757 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10759 #ifdef USE_GTK
10760 current_count = -1;
10761 #endif
10763 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10764 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10766 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10767 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10769 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10771 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10772 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10773 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10774 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10775 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10776 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10777 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10779 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10780 #endif
10782 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10783 #ifndef USE_GTK
10784 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10785 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10786 #endif
10787 #endif
10789 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10790 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10791 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10793 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10794 original error handler. */
10795 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10796 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10798 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10800 xgselect_initialize ();
10804 void
10805 syms_of_xterm (void)
10807 x_error_message = NULL;
10809 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10810 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10812 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10813 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10815 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10816 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10818 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10819 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10821 #ifdef USE_GTK
10822 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10823 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10825 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10826 #endif
10828 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10829 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10830 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10831 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10832 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10833 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10834 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10835 sizes. */);
10836 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10838 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10839 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10840 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10841 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10842 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10843 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10844 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10846 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10847 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10848 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10849 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10850 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10851 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10852 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10853 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10854 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10856 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10857 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10858 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10859 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10860 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10861 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10862 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10863 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10864 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10865 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10866 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10867 #elif USE_GTK
10868 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10869 #else
10870 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10871 #endif
10872 #else
10873 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10874 #endif
10876 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10877 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10879 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10880 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10881 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10882 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10883 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10884 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10885 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10886 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10887 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10889 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10890 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10891 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10892 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10893 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10894 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10896 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10897 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10898 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10899 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10900 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10901 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10903 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10904 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10905 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10906 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10907 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10908 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10910 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10911 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10912 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10913 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10914 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10915 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10917 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10918 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10919 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10920 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10921 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10922 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10925 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */